Lexmark MS812DN

Product's Documents

Below are documents related to this product, you can read online or download:
Other Documents
  • User's Guide PDF Lexmark MS810, MS811, MS812, MS817, MS818 - (English) Read Online | Download pdf
  • Quick Reference Lexmark MS810 Series - (English) Download
  • Printer Data Cleanup Guide PDF - (English) Download
  • Forms and Bar Code Card 3.3 User's Guide - (English) Download
  • Virtual Configuration Center Administrator's Guide - (English) Download
  • Embedded Web Server Administrator's Guide - (English) Download
  • Card Stock and Label Guide - (English) Download
  • Universal Print Driver Version 3.0a White Paper - (English) Download
  • Product Information Guide - (English) Download
  • Printer, Option, and Stand Compatibility Guide - (English) Download
  • Printer Drivers for UNIX & Linux Systems - (English) Download
  • Paper and Specialty Media Guide PDF - (English) Download
  • Default-to-Duplex Driver Information Guide - (English) Download
Specification
  • Technical Reference PDF Lexmark MS710 Series, MS810 Series, MX710 Series, MX810 Series - (English) Download
  • PRESCRIBE Emulation P41g Technical Reference — July 2017 - (English) Download
MS812DN photo

User's Guide PDF Lexmark MS810, MS811, MS812, MS817, MS818

This is the main product document for model MS812DN.

The file format is pdf, 362 pages, you can download this manual here .

background
MS810, MS811, MS812, MS817,
MS818
User's Guide
Important: Click here before using this guide.
September 2022 www.lexmark.com
Machine type(s):
4063
Model(s):
210, 230, 23E, 410, 430, 630, 63E
background
Contents
Safety information........................................................................................ 5
Conventions.......................................................................................................................................................... 5
Overview........................................................................................................ 8
Using this guide....................................................................................................................................................8
Finding information about the printer.............................................................................................................8
Selecting a location for the printer........................................................... 10
Additional printer setup..............................................................................12
Installing internal options................................................................................................................................. 12
Installing hardware options............................................................................................................................ 29
Attaching cables................................................................................................................................................ 33
Setting up the printer software......................................................................................................................35
Networking..........................................................................................................................................................36
Verifying printer setup......................................................................................................................................40
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn,
MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn.................................................................... 41
Learning about the printer............................................................................................................................... 41
Loading paper and specialty media............................................................................................................. 44
Printing.................................................................................................................................................................66
Managing your printer......................................................................................................................................72
Using MS810de...........................................................................................83
Learning about the printer.............................................................................................................................. 83
Setting up and using the home screen applications...............................................................................89
Loading paper and specialty media.............................................................................................................93
Printing.................................................................................................................................................................113
Managing your printer....................................................................................................................................120
Using MS812de......................................................................................... 130
Learning about the printer.............................................................................................................................130
Setting up and using the home screen applications.............................................................................. 137
Loading paper and specialty media.............................................................................................................141
Contents 2
background
Printing................................................................................................................................................................162
Managing your printer.................................................................................................................................... 168
Paper and specialty media guide............................................................178
Using specialty media.....................................................................................................................................178
Paper guidelines.............................................................................................................................................. 180
Supported paper sizes, types, and weights..............................................................................................183
Understanding the printer menus.......................................................... 189
Menus list...........................................................................................................................................................189
Paper menu.......................................................................................................................................................190
Reports menu................................................................................................................................................... 201
Network/Ports menu......................................................................................................................................202
Security menu...................................................................................................................................................215
Settings menu..................................................................................................................................................220
Help menu........................................................................................................................................................ 245
Saving money and the environment......................................................247
Adjusting the brightness of the printer display.......................................................................................247
Saving paper and toner.................................................................................................................................247
Recycling...........................................................................................................................................................248
Maintaining the printer............................................................................250
Ordering supplies...........................................................................................................................................250
Storing supplies...............................................................................................................................................253
Replacing supplies......................................................................................................................................... 254
Cleaning printer parts....................................................................................................................................260
Moving the printer.......................................................................................................................................... 262
Clearing jams............................................................................................ 263
Avoiding jams.................................................................................................................................................. 263
Identifying jam locations...............................................................................................................................265
Paper jam in the front door...........................................................................................................................267
Paper jam in the rear door............................................................................................................................268
Paper jam in the standard bin.......................................................................................................................271
Paper jam in the duplex unit......................................................................................................................... 271
Paper jam in trays............................................................................................................................................272
Paper jam in the multipurpose feeder.......................................................................................................273
Contents 3
background
Paper jam in the staple finisher...................................................................................................................274
Staple jam in the finisher...............................................................................................................................276
Paper jam in the output expander..............................................................................................................279
Paper jam in the mailbox.............................................................................................................................. 280
Troubleshooting....................................................................................... 282
Understanding the printer messages........................................................................................................282
Solving printer problems................................................................................................................................301
Solving home screen application problems.............................................................................................337
Embedded Web Server does not open.................................................................................................... 338
Contacting customer support......................................................................................................................339
Notices.......................................................................................................340
Product information........................................................................................................................................340
Edition notice................................................................................................................................................... 340
Power consumption........................................................................................................................................344
Index...........................................................................................................353
Contents 4
background
Safety information
Conventions
Note: A note identifies information that could help you.
Warning: A warning identifies something that could damage the product hardware or software.
CAUTION: A caution indicates a potentially hazardous situation that could injure you.
Dierent types of caution statements include:
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Indicates a risk of injury.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Indicates a risk of electrical shock.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: Indicates a risk of burn if touched.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Indicates a crush hazard.
CAUTION—PINCH HAZARD: Indicates a risk of being caught between moving parts.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord to
an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not use this product with extension cords, multioutlet power strips,
multioutlet extenders, or UPS devices. The power capacity of these types of accessories can be easily
overloaded by a laser printer and may result in a risk of fire, property damage, or poor printer
performance.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not place or use this product near
water or wet locations.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: This product uses a laser. Use of controls or adjustments or
performance of procedures other than those specified in the User’s Guide may result in hazardous
radiation exposure.
This product uses a printing process that heats the print media, and the heat may cause the media to release
emissions. You must understand the section in your operating instructions that discusses the guidelines for
selecting print media to avoid the possibility of harmful emissions.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The lithium battery in this product is not intended to be replaced.
There is a danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced. Do not recharge, disassemble,
or incinerate a lithium battery. Discard used lithium batteries according to the manufacturer's instructions
and local regulations.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or
more trained personnel to lift it safely.
Safety information 5
background
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: When moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal
injury or printer damage:
Make sure that all doors and trays are closed.
Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer.
If the printer has a caster base, then carefully roll it to the new location. Use caution when passing over
thresholds and breaks in flooring.
If the printer does not have a caster base but is configured with optional trays, then lift the printer o the
trays. Do not try to lift the printer and the trays at the same time.
Always use the handholds on the printer to lift it.
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the
options.
Keep the printer in an upright position.
Avoid severe jarring movements.
Make sure that your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.
Make sure that there is adequate clearance around the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer o, and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, make sure that all external
connections (such as Ethernet and telephone system connections) are properly installed in their marked
plug-in ports.
This product is designed, tested, and approved to meet strict global safety standards with the use of specific
manufacturer's components. The safety features of some parts may not always be obvious. The manufacturer
is not responsible for the use of other replacement parts.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not cut, twist, bind, crush, or place heavy objects on the power
cord. Do not subject the power cord to abrasion or stress. Do not pinch the power cord between objects
such as furniture and walls. If any of these things happen, a risk of fire or electrical shock results. Inspect
the power cord regularly for signs of such problems. Remove the power cord from the electrical outlet
before inspecting it.
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the user documentation, to a service representative.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not set up this product or make any electrical or cabling connections,
such as a power cord, a fax feature or USB cable, during a lightning storm.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability.
You must use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you
purchased a printer with a similar configuration, then you may need additional furniture. For more
information, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Safety information 6
background
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS.
Safety information 7
background
Overview
Using this guide
This User’s Guide provides general and specific information on using the printer models that are listed on the
cover page.
The following chapters contain information applicable to all printer models:
Safety information
Selecting a location for the printer
Additional printer setup
Paper and specialty media guide
Understanding printer menus
Saving money and the environment
Maintaining the printer
Clearing jams
Troubleshooting
To find instructions for your printer:
Use the table of contents.
Use the Search function or the Find toolbar of your application to search for page content.
Finding information about the printer
What are you looking for? Find it here
Initial setup instructions:
Connecting the printer
Installing the printer software
Setup documentation—The setup documentation
came with the printer and is also available at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Additional setup and instructions for using the printer:
Selecting and storing paper and specialty media
Loading paper
Configuring
printer settings
Viewing and printing documents and photos
Setting up and using the printer software
Configuring the printer on a network
Caring for and maintaining the printer
Troubleshooting and solving problems
User's Guide and Quick Reference Guide—The
guides are available at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Note: These guides are also available in other
languages.
Information on setting up and configuring the accessibility
features of your printer
Lexmark Accessibility Guide—This guide is available
at http://support.lexmark.com.
Overview 8
background
What are you looking for? Find it here
Help using the printer software Windows or Mac Help—Open a printer software
program or application, and then click Help.
Click
?
to view contextsensitive information.
Notes:
Help is automatically installed with the printer
software.
The printer software is located in the printer
program folder or on the desktop, depending
on your operating system.
The latest supplemental information, updates, and customer
support:
Documentation
Driver downloads
Live chat support
Email support
Voice support
Lexmark support Web site—
http://support.lexmark.com
Note: Select your country or region, and then select
your product to view the appropriate support site.
Support telephone numbers and hours of operation
for your country or region can be found on the
support Web site or on the printed warranty that came
with your printer.
Record the following information (located on the
store receipt and at the back of the printer), and have
it ready when you contact customer support so that
they may serve you faster:
Machine Type number
Serial number
Date purchased
Store where purchased
Warranty information Warranty information varies by country or region:
In the U.S.—See the Statement of Limited
Warranty included with this printer, or go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
In other countries and regions—See the printed
warranty that came with this printer.
Overview 9
background
Selecting a location for the printer
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or
more trained personnel to lift it safely.
When selecting a location for the printer, leave enough room to open trays, covers, and doors. If you plan to
install any hardware options, then leave enough room for them also. It is important to:
Set up the printer near a properly grounded and easily accessible electrical outlet.
Make sure
airflow
in the room meets the latest revision of the ASHRAE 62 standard or the CEN Technical
Committee 156 standard.
Provide a
flat,
sturdy, and stable surface.
Keep the printer:
Clean, dry, and free of dust.
Away from stray staples and paper clips.
Away from the direct airflow of air conditioners, heaters, or ventilators.
Free from direct sunlight and humidity extremes.
Observe the recommended temperatures and avoid fluctuations:
Ambient temperature 15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)
Storage temperature 40 to 60°C (-40 to 140°F)
1 Right side 152 mm (6 in.)
2 Front 508 mm (20 in.)
3 Left side 152 mm (6 in.)
4 Rear 152 mm (6 in.)
5 Top 115 mm (4.5 in.)
Selecting a location for the printer 10
background
1 Right side 152 mm (6 in.)
2 Front 508 mm (20 in.)
3 Left side 152 mm (6 in.)
4 Rear 152 mm (6 in.)
5 Top 115 mm (4.5 in.)
1 Right side 152 mm (6 in.)
2 Front 508 mm (20 in.)
3 Left side 152 mm (6 in.)
4 Rear 152 mm (6 in.)
5 Top 115 mm (4.5 in.)
Selecting a location for the printer 11
background
Additional printer setup
Installing internal options
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer o, and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
Available internal options
Memory card
DDR3 DIMM
Flash memory
Fonts
Firmware cards
Forms and Bar Code
PRESCRIBE
IPDS
Printer hard disk
Lexmark
TM
Internal Solutions Ports (ISP)
Parallel 1284-B interface
MarkNet
TM
N8350 802.11 b/g/n wireless printer server
RS-232-C serial interface
Accessing the controller board
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer o, and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
1 Remove the controller board access cover.
1
2
Additional printer setup 12
background
2 Using a screwdriver, loosen the screws on the controller board shield.
3 Remove the shield.
Additional printer setup 13
background
4 Use the following illustration to locate the appropriate connector:
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer
first
before touching any controller board electronic
component or connector.
1
3
2
1 Lexmark Internal Solutions Port or printer hard disk connector
2 Option card connector
3 Memory card connector
Additional printer setup 14
background
5 Align the screws with the holes on the shield, and then reattach the shield.
6 Tighten the screws on the shield.
Additional printer setup 15
background
7 Reattach the access cover.
2
1
Installing a memory card
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer
o,
and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch something metal on the printer first before touching any controller board electronic
components or connectors.
An optional memory card can be purchased separately and attached to the controller board.
1 Access the controller board.
For more information, see
Accessing the controller board” on page 12.
2 Unpack the memory card.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the connection points along the edge of the card. Doing so
may cause damage.
3 Align the notch (1) on the memory card with the ridge (2) on the connector.
1
2
Additional printer setup 16
background
4 Push the memory card straight into the connector, and then push the card toward the controller board wall
until it clicks into place.
5 Reattach the controller board shield, and then the controller board access cover.
Installing an Internal Solutions Port
The controller board supports one optional Lexmark Internal Solutions Port (ISP).
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer o, and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch something metal on the printer
first
before touching any controller board electronic
components or connectors.
1 Access the controller board.
For more information, see Accessing the controller board” on page 12.
2 If an optional printer hard disk is installed, then remove the printer hard disk first.
For more information, see
“Removing a printer hard disk” on page 27.
Additional printer setup 17
background
3 Unpack the ISP kit.
2
3
4
1
1 ISP solution
2 Screw for attaching the plastic bracket to the ISP
3 Screws for attaching the ISP mounting bracket to the controller board shield
4 Plastic bracket
4 Remove the metal cover from the ISP opening.
a Loosen the screw.
b Lift the metal cover, and then pull it out completely.
Additional printer setup 18
background
1 2 3
5 Align the posts of the plastic bracket with the holes on the controller board cage, and then press the plastic
bracket on the controller board cage until it clicks into place. Make sure the cables are neatly tucked under
the plastic bracket.
6 Install the ISP on the plastic bracket.
Note: Hold the ISP at an angle over the plastic bracket so that any overhanging connectors will pass
through the ISP opening in the controller board cage.
Additional printer setup 19
background
7 Lower the ISP toward the plastic bracket until the ISP is seated between the guides of the plastic bracket.
8 Use the provided thumbscrew for the ISP to attach the plastic bracket to the ISP.
Note: Turn the screw clockwise, enough to hold the ISP in place, but do not tighten it yet.
Additional printer setup 20
background
9 Attach the two provided screws to secure the ISP mounting bracket to the controller board shield.
10 Tighten the thumbscrew that is attached to the ISP.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not screw it on too tightly.
11 Connect the ISP solution interface cable into the receptacle of the controller board.
Note: The plugs and receptacles are color-coded.
Additional printer setup 21
background
Installing an optional card
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer
o,
and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have other devices attached to the printer, then
turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components
or connectors.
1 Access the controller board.
For more information, see Accessing the controller board” on page 12.
2 Unpack the optional card.
Warning—Potential Damage: Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card.
3 Holding the card by its sides, align the plastic pins (1) on the card with the holes (2) on the controller board.
1
2
4 Push the card firmly into place as shown in the illustration.
Additional printer setup 22
background
Warning—Potential Damage: Improper installation of the card may cause damage to the card and the
controller board.
Note: The entire length of the connector on the card must touch and be flushed against the controller
board.
5 Close the controller board access door.
Note: When the printer software and any hardware options are installed, it may be necessary to manually
add the options in the printer driver to make them available for print jobs. For more information, see
Adding available options in the print driver” on page 35.
Installing a printer hard disk
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer o, and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch something metal on the printer
first
before touching any controller board electronic
components or connectors.
1 Access the controller board.
For more information, see
Accessing the controller board” on page 12.
2 Unpack the printer hard disk.
Additional printer setup 23
background
3 Locate the appropriate connector on the controller board cage.
Note: If an optional ISP is currently installed, then the printer hard disk must be installed onto the ISP.
Additional printer setup 24
background
To install a printer hard disk onto the ISP:
a Remove the screws attached to the printer hard disk mounting bracket, and then remove the bracket.
b Align the standos of the printer hard disk to the holes in the ISP, and then press the printer hard disk
down until the standos are in place.
Installation warning: Hold only the edges of the printed circuit board assembly. Do not touch or press
on the center of the printer hard disk. Doing so may cause damage.
c Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the ISP.
Note: The plugs and receptacles are colorcoded.
Additional printer setup 25
background
4 Align the standos of the printer hard disk to the holes in the controller board cage, and then press the
printer hard disk down until the standos are in place.
Installation warning: Hold only the edges of the printed circuit board assembly. Do not touch or press on
the center of the printer hard disk. Doing so may cause damage.
Note: Make sure the cables are neatly tucked under the printer hard disk.
5 Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the controller board.
Note: The plugs and receptacles are colorcoded.
Additional printer setup 26
background
Removing a printer hard disk
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer o, and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
Additional printer setup 27
background
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components
or connectors.
1 Access the controller board.
For more information, see
Accessing the controller board” on page 12.
2 Unplug the printer hard disk interface cable from the controller board, leaving the cable attached to the
printer hard disk. To unplug the cable, squeeze the paddle at the plug of the interface cable to disengage
the latch before pulling out the cable.
3 Remove the screws holding the printer hard disk in place.
Additional printer setup 28
background
4 Remove the printer hard disk.
5 Set aside the printer hard disk.
Installing hardware options
Order of installation
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or
more trained personnel to lift it safely.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer o, and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted
configurations
require additional furniture for stability.
You must use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you
purchased a printer with a similar configuration, then you may need additional furniture. For more
information, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Install the printer and any hardware options you have purchased in the following order:
Caster base
2100sheet tray or spacer
Optional 550 or 250sheet tray
Printer
For more information on installing a caster base, optional 550 or 250sheet tray, spacer, or 2100sheet tray,
see the setup sheet that came with the option.
Additional printer setup 29
background
Installing optional trays
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or
more trained personnel to lift it safely.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware
or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer
o,
and unplug the power
cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer,
then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability.
You must use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you
purchased a printer with a similar configuration, then you may need additional furniture. For more
information, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
1 Turn o the printer using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Unpack the optional tray, and then remove all packing material.
3 Pull out the tray completely from the base.
4 Remove any packing material from inside the tray.
5 Insert the tray into the base.
6 Place the tray near the printer.
7 Align the optional tray with the caster base.
Note: Make sure to lock the wheels of the caster base to secure the printer.
Additional printer setup 30
background
8 Align the printer with the tray, and then slowly lower the printer into place.
Note: Optional trays lock together when stacked.
Additional printer setup 31
background
9 Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly grounded electrical outlet, and then turn on the
printer.
Additional printer setup 32
background
Note: When the printer software and any optional trays are installed, you may need to manually add the
options in the printer driver to make them available for print jobs. For more information, see
“Adding
available options in the print driver” on page 35.
To uninstall the optional trays, slide the latch on the right side of the printer toward the front of the printer until
it clicks into place, and then remove stacked trays one at a time from the top to the bottom.
Attaching cables
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not set up this product or make any electrical or cabling
connections, such as a power cord, a fax feature, or USB cable, during a lightning storm.
Connect the printer to the computer using a USB cable or Ethernet cable.
Make sure to match the following:
The USB symbol on the cable with the USB symbol on the printer
The appropriate Ethernet cable to the Ethernet port
The appropriate parallel cable with the parallel port
Additional printer setup 33
background
1
2
3
4
6
5
Use the To
1 Parallel port Connect the printer to a computer.
Note: This can also be used in installing an optional Internal Solutions Port
(ISP).
2 USB port Attach an optional wireless network adapter.
3 Ethernet port Connect the printer to a network.
4 USB printer port Connect the printer to a computer.
5 Security slot Attach a lock that will secure the controller board.
6 Printer power cord socket Connect the printer to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the USB cable, any wireless network adapter, or the printer in the
area shown while actively printing. Loss of data or a malfunction can occur.
Note: This feature is available only if you purchase optional trays and a caster base.
After attaching the Ethernet cable and power cord, neatly tuck the cables in the channels at the back of the printer.
Additional printer setup 34
background
Setting up the printer software
Installing the printer software
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.
From the software CD that came with your printer.
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then select your printer and operating system.
2 Run the installer, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.
3 For Macintosh users, add the printer.
Note: Obtain the printer IP address from the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu.
Adding available options in the print driver
For Windows users
1 Open the printers folder.
2 Select the printer you want to update, and then do the following:
For Windows 7 or later, select Printer properties.
For earlier versions, select Properties.
Additional printer setup 35
background
3 Navigate to the Configuration tab, and then select Update Now Ask Printer.
4 Apply the changes.
For Macintosh users
1 From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer, and then select Options & Supplies.
2 Navigate to the list of hardware options, and then add any installed options.
3 Apply the changes.
Networking
Notes:
Purchase a MarkNet N8350 wireless network adapter before setting up the printer on a wireless
network. For information on installing the wireless network adapter, see the instruction sheet that came
with the adapter.
A Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name assigned to a wireless network. Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP),
Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA), WPA2, and 802.1X-RADIUS are types of security used on a network.
Preparing to set up the printer on an Ethernet network
To configure your printer to connect to an Ethernet network, organize the following information before you
begin:
Note: If your network automatically assigns IP addresses to computers and printers, continue on to installing
the printer.
A valid, unique IP address for the printer to use on the network
The network gateway
The network mask
A nickname for the printer (optional)
Note: A printer nickname can make it easier for you to identify your printer on the network. You can
choose to use the default printer nickname, or assign a name that is easier for you to remember.
You will need an Ethernet cable to connect the printer to the network and an available port where the printer
can physically connect to the network. Use a new network cable when possible to avoid potential problems
caused by a damaged cable.
Preparing to set up the printer on a wireless network
Notes:
Make sure your wireless network adapter is installed in your printer and working properly. For more
information, see the instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.
Make sure your access point (wireless router) is turned on and is working properly.
Additional printer setup 36
background
Make sure you have the following information before setting up the printer on a wireless network:
SSID—The SSID is also referred to as the network name.
Wireless Mode (or Network Mode)—The mode is either infrastructure or ad hoc.
Channel (for ad hoc networks)—The channel defaults to automatic for infrastructure networks.
Some ad hoc networks will also require the automatic setting. Check with your system support person if
you are not sure which channel to select.
Security Method—There are four basic options for Security Method:
WEP key
If your network uses more than one WEP key, then enter up to four in the provided spaces. Select the
key currently in use on the network by selecting the default WEP transmit key.
WPA or WPA2 preshared key or passphrase
WPA includes encryption as an additional layer of security. The choices are AES or TKIP. Encryption must
be set for the same type on the router and on the printer, or the printer will not be able to communicate
on the network.
802.1X–RADIUS
If you are installing the printer on an 802.1X network, then you may need the following:
Authentication type
Inner authentication type
802.1X user name and password
Certificates
No security
If your wireless network does not use any type of security, then you will not have any security information.
Note: We do not recommend using an unsecured wireless network.
Notes:
If you do not know the SSID of the network that your computer is connected to, then launch the wireless
utility of the computer network adapter, and then look for the network name. If you cannot find the SSID
or the security information for your network, then see the documentation that came with the access
point, or contact your system support person.
To find the WPA/WPA2 preshared key or passphrase for the wireless network, see the documentation
that came with the access point, see the Embedded Web Server associated with the access point, or
consult your system support person.
Connecting the printer to a network using the Wireless Setup Wizard
Before you begin, make sure that:
A wireless network adapter is installed in the printer and is working properly. For more information, see the
instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.
The Ethernet cable is disconnected from the printer.
Active NIC is set to Auto. To set this to Auto, navigate to one of the following:
> Settings > > Network/Ports > > Active NIC > > Auto >
> Network/Ports > Active NIC > Auto
Additional printer setup 37
background
> Network/Ports > Active NIC > Auto > Submit
Note: Make sure to turn o the printer, then wait for at least five seconds, and then turn on the printer.
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to one of the following:
> Settings > > Network/Ports > > Network [x] > > Network [x] Setup > > Wireless
>
> Wireless Connection Setup >
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > Wireless Connection Setup
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > Wireless Connection Setup
2 Select a wireless connection setup.
Use To
Search for networks Show available wireless connections.
Note: This menu shows all broadcast secured or unsecured SSIDs.
Enter a network name Manually enter the SSID.
Note: Make sure to enter the correct SSID.
WiFi Protected Setup Connect the printer to a wireless network using WiFi Protected Setup.
3 Follow the instructions on the printer display.
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using the Wi-Fi Protected
Setup
Before connecting the printer to a wireless network, make sure that:
The access point (wireless router) is WiFi Protected Setup (WPS) certified or WPScompatible. For more
information, see the documentation that came with your access point.
A wireless network adapter installed in your printer is attached and working properly. For more information,
see the instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.
Using the Push Button Configuration method
1
Depending on your printer model, navigate to either of the following:
> Settings > > Networks/Ports > > Network [x] > > Network [x] Setup > >
Wireless >
> WiFi Protected Setup > > Start Push Button Method
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > WiFi Protected Setup > Start
Push Button Method
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > WiFi Protected Setup > Start
Push Button Method
2 Follow the instructions on the printer display.
Additional printer setup 38
background
Using the Personal Identification Number (PIN) method
1
Depending on your printer model, navigate to either of the following:
> Settings > > Networks/Ports > > Network [x] > > Network [x] Setup > >
Wireless >
> WiFi Protected Setup > > Start PIN Method
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > WiFi Protected Setup > Start
PIN Method
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > WiFi Protected Setup > Start
PIN Method
2 Copy the eight–digit WPS PIN.
3 Open a Web browser, and then type the IP address of your access point in the address field.
Notes:
The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
4 Access the WPS settings. For more information, see the documentation that came with your access
point.
5 Enter the eightdigit PIN, and then save the setting.
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using the Embedded Web
Server
Before you begin, make sure that:
Your printer is connected temporarily to an Ethernet network.
A wireless network adapter is installed in your printer and working properly. For more information, see the
instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless.
3 Modify the settings to match the settings of your access point (wireless router).
Note: Make sure to enter the correct SSID, security method, preshared key or passphrase, network
mode, and channel.
4 Click Submit.
5 Turn o the printer, and then disconnect the Ethernet cable. Then wait for at least five seconds, and then
turn the printer back on.
6 To verify if your printer is connected to the network, print a network setup page. Then in the Network Card
[x] section, see if the status is Connected.
Additional printer setup 39
background
Setting up serial printing (Windows only)
1 Set the parameters in the printer.
a From the control panel, navigate to the menu for the port settings.
b Locate the menu for the serial port settings, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
c Apply the changes.
2 From your computer, open the printers folder, and then select your printer.
3 Open the printer properties, and then select the COM port from the list.
4 Set the COM port parameters in Device Manager.
Notes:
Serial printing reduces printing speed.
Make sure that the serial cable is connected to the serial port on your printer.
Verifying printer setup
When all hardware and software options are installed and the printer is turned on, verify that the printer is set
up correctly by printing the following:
Menu settings page—Use this page to verify that all printer options are installed correctly. A list of installed
options appears toward the bottom of the page. If an option you installed is not listed, then it is not installed
correctly. Remove the option, and then install it again.
For more information, see the following:
“Printing a menu settings page” on page 74 for nontouchscreen printer models
“Printing a menu settings page” on page 122 or “Printing a menu settings page” on page 170 for
touchscreen printer models
Network setup page—Use this page to verify the network connection. This page also provides important
information that aids network printing configuration.
Note: Make sure your printer has Ethernet or wireless capability and is attached to a network.
For more information, see the following:
“Printing a network setup page” on page 75 for nontouchscreen printer models
“Printing a network setup page” on page 122 or “Printing a network setup page” on page 170 for
touchscreen printer models
Additional printer setup 40
background
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn,
MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn
Learning about the printer
Printer
configurations
Basic model
1 Standard bin
2 Printer control panel
3 Multipurpose feeder
4 Standard 550sheet tray (Tray 1)
Fully configured model
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability.
You must use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you
purchased a printer with a similar configuration, then you may need additional furniture. For more
information, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 41
background
The following illustration shows the maximum number of optional finishers and trays that are supported by the
printer. For more information on other configurations, visit
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Hardware option Alternative hardware option
1 Staple finisher
Output expander
4bin mailbox
Staple, hole punch finisher
2 4bin mailbox
Staple finisher
Staple, hole punch
finisher
Output expander
3 Caster base None
4 2100sheet tray None
5 550sheet tray 250sheet tray
6 250sheet tray 550sheet tray
7 4bin mailbox Output expander
8 Output expander 4bin mailbox
The staple, hole punch finisher must not be combined with any other output options.
In a configuration with two or more optional finishers:
The staple
finisher
must always be on top.
The highcapacity output expander must always be at the bottom.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 42
background
The output expander is the only option that can be placed on top of the highcapacity output expander.
The output expander and mailbox may be installed in any order.
When using optional trays:
Always use a caster base when the printer is configured with a 2100sheet tray.
The 2100sheet tray must always be at the bottom of a configuration.
A maximum of four optional trays may be configured with the printer.
The optional 250 and 550sheet trays may be installed in any order.
Using the printer control panel
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Use the To
1 Display
View the printer status.
Set up and operate the printer.
2 Select button Submit changes made in the printer settings.
3 Arrow buttons Scroll up and down or left and right.
4 Keypad Enter numbers, letters, or symbols.
5 Sleep button Enable Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.
Do the following to wake the printer from Sleep mode:
Press any hard button.
Pull out Tray 1 or load paper in the multipurpose feeder.
Open a door or cover.
Send a print job from the computer.
Perform a poweron reset with the main power switch.
Attach a device to the USB port on the printer.
6 Stop or Cancel button Stop all printer activity.
7 Back button Return to the previous screen.
8 Home button Go to the home screen.
9 Indicator light Check the status of the printer.
10 USB port Connect a flash drive to the printer.
Note: Only the front USB port supports
flash
drives.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 43
background
Understanding the colors of the Sleep button and indicator lights
The colors of the Sleep button and indicator lights on the printer control panel signify a certain printer status
or condition.
Indicator light Printer status
O The printer is o or in Hibernate mode.
Blinking green The printer is warming up, processing data, or printing.
Solid green The printer is on, but idle.
Blinking red The printer requires user intervention.
Sleep button light Printer status
O The printer is o, idle or in Ready state.
Solid amber The printer is in Sleep mode.
Blinking amber The printer is entering or waking from Hibernate mode.
Blinking amber for 0.1 second, then goes
completely o for 1.9 seconds in a slow,
pulsing pattern
The printer is in Hibernate mode.
Loading paper and specialty media
The selection and handling of paper and specialty media can
aect
how reliably documents print. For more
information, see
Avoiding jams” on page 263 and “Storing paper” on page 182.
Setting the paper size and type
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Paper Menu > > Paper Size/Type >
2 Press the up or down arrow button to select the tray or feeder, and then press .
3 Press the up or down arrow button to select the paper size, and then press .
4 Press the up or down arrow button to select the paper type, and then press to change the settings.
Configuring Universal paper settings
The Universal paper size is a userdefined setting that lets you print on paper sizes that are not preset in the
printer menus.
Notes:
The smallest supported Universal size is 70 x 127 mm (2.76 x 5 inches) for onesided printing and 105 x
148 mm (4.13 x 5.83 inches) for twosided (duplex) printing.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 44
background
The largest supported Universal size is 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches) for onesided and twosided
printing.
When printing on paper less than 210 mm (8.3 inches) wide, the printer may print at a reduced speed
after a period of time to ensure the best print performance.
If you regularly print large jobs on narrow paper, then you may use the MS710 Series printer models,
which print batches of 10 or more pages of narrow paper at a faster speed. For more information on the
MS710 Series printer models, contact your Lexmark sales representative.
From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Paper Menu > > Universal Setup > > Units of Measure > > select unit of
measure >
Loading the 250 or 550sheet tray
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Pull out the tray.
Notes:
When loading folio, legal, or Oficiosize paper, lift the tray slightly and pull it out completely.
Avoid removing trays while a job prints or while Busy appears on the display. Doing so may cause a
jam.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 45
background
2 Squeeze and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until it clicks
into place.
Note: Use the paper size indicators at the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 46
background
3 Unlock the length guide, and then squeeze and slide the guide to the correct position for the size of the
paper being loaded.
Notes:
Lock the length guide for all paper sizes.
Use the paper size indicators at the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 47
background
4 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten
the edges on a level surface.
5 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.
Note: Make sure the paper or envelope is loaded properly.
There are dierent ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is
installed or not.
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 48
background
Do not slide the paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.
If you are loading envelopes, then make sure that the flap side is facing up and the envelopes are on
the left side of the tray.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 49
background
Make sure the paper is below the solid line, which is the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage:
Overfilling
the tray can cause paper jams.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 50
background
When using card stock, labels, or other types of specialty media, make sure the paper is below the
dashed line, which is the alternate paper
fill
indicator.
6 For custom or Universalsize paper, adjust the paper guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack, and then
lock the length guide.
7 Insert the tray.
8 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and paper type in the Paper menu to match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 51
background
Loading the 2100sheet tray
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Pull out the tray.
2 Adjust the width and length guides.
Loading A5size paper
a
Pull up and slide the width guide to the position for A5.
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A
4
A
5
1
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A
4
A
5
2
L
GL
O
F
C
FOL
IO
LTR
A
4
A
5
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 52
background
b Squeeze and slide the length guide to the position for A5 until it clicks into place.
1
2
c Remove the A5 length guide from its holder.
1
2
d Insert the A5 length guide into its designated slot.
Note: Press the A5 length guide until it clicks into place.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 53
background
Loading A4, letter, legal, oficio, and foliosize paper
a
Pull up and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.
L
G
L
O
F
C
F
O
L
IO
L
T
R
A
4
A
5
1
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A4
A5
2
LG
L
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A4
A5
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 54
background
b If the A5 length guide is still attached to the length guide, then remove it from its place. If the A5 length
guide is not attached, then proceed to step d.
c Put the A5 length guide in its holder.
2
1
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 55
background
d Squeeze the length guide and slide it to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until
it clicks into place.
3 Flex and fan the sheets to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten the
edges on a level surface.
4 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.
Note: Make sure the paper is loaded properly.
There are
dierent
ways for loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple
finisher
is
installed or not.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 56
background
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 57
background
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the tray can cause paper jams.
5 Insert the tray.
Note: Press the paper stack down while inserting the tray.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 58
background
6 From the printer control panel, set the size and type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the
tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Loading the multipurpose feeder
1 Pull down the multipurpose feeder door.
Note: Do not load or close the multipurpose feeder while a job is printing.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A
4
A
5
LT
R
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 59
background
2 Pull the multipurpose feeder extender.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A
4
A
5
L
T
R
Note: Guide the extender gently so that the multipurpose feeder is fully extended and open.
3 Slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.
B5
EXEC
A
4
A
5
LT R
Note: Use the paper size indicators on the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 60
background
B
5
E
X
E
C
A4 A5
LTR
4 Prepare the paper or specialty media for loading.
Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Hold transparencies by the edges, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Note: Avoid touching the printable side of the transparencies. Be careful not to scratch them.
Flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on
a level surface.
5 Load paper or specialty media.
Note: Slide the stack gently into the multipurpose feeder until it comes to a stop.
Load only one size and type of paper or specialty media at a time.
Make sure the paper fits loosely in the multipurpose feeder, lies flat, and is not bent or wrinkled.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 61
background
There are dierent ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is
installed or not.
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple
finisher,
then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 62
background
Load envelopes with the flap side down and on the left of the multipurpose feeder.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A
4
A
5
LT
R
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated
linings, or selfstick adhesives. These envelopes may severely damage the printer.
Make sure the paper or specialty media is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the feeder can cause paper jams.
6 For custom- or Universal-size paper, adjust the width guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack.
7 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and paper type in the Paper menu to match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 63
background
Linking and unlinking trays
The printer links trays when the specified paper size and type are the same. When a linked tray becomes empty,
paper feeds from the next linked tray. To prevent trays from linking, assign a unique custom paper type name.
Linking and unlinking trays
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel in the TCP/IP section under the
Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as
123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu.
3 Change the paper size and type settings for the trays you are linking.
To link trays, make sure the paper size and type for the tray match that of the other tray.
To unlink trays, make sure the paper size or type for the tray does not match that of the other tray.
4 Click Submit.
Note: You can also change the paper size and type settings using the printer control panel. For more
information, see
“Setting the paper size and type” on page 44.
Warning—Potential Damage: Paper loaded in the tray should match the paper type name assigned in the
printer. The temperature of the fuser varies according to the
specified
paper type. Printing issues may occur
if settings are not properly configured.
Creating a custom name for a paper type
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Names.
3 Select a custom name, and then type a new custom paper type name.
4 Click Submit.
5 Click Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 64
background
Using the printer control panel
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Paper Menu > > Custom Names
2 Select a custom name, and then type a new custom paper type name.
3 Press .
4 Press Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.
Assigning a custom paper type
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Types.
3 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.
4 Click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Paper Menu > > Custom Types
2 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all user
defined
custom names.
3 Press .
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 65
background
Printing
Printing a document
Printing from a computer
Note: For labels, card stock, and envelopes, set the paper size and type in the printer before sending the
print job.
1 From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 If necessary, adjust the settings.
3 Send the print job.
Adjusting toner darkness
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the IP address of the printer in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Toner Darkness.
3 Adjust the toner darkness, and then click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Settings > > Print Settings > > Quality Menu > > Toner Darkness
2 Adjust the toner darkness, and then press .
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 66
background
Printing from a flash drive
Printing from a flash drive
Notes:
Before printing an encrypted PDF file, you will be prompted to enter the file password from the printer
control panel.
You cannot print files for which you do not have printing permissions.
1 Insert a flash drive into the USB port.
Notes:
A flash drive icon appears on the printer control panel and in the held jobs icon when a flash drive is
installed.
If you insert the flash drive when the printer requires attention, such as when a jam has occurred,
then the printer ignores the
flash
drive.
If you insert the
flash
drive while the printer is processing other print jobs, then Busy appears. After
these print jobs are processed, you may need to view the held jobs list to print documents from the
flash
drive.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the printer or the flash drive in the area shown while actively
printing, reading, or writing from the memory device. Loss of data can occur.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 67
background
2 From the printer control panel, select the document you want to print.
3 Press the left or right arrow button to specify the number of copies for printing, and then press .
Notes:
Do not remove the flash drive from the USB port until the document has finished printing.
If you leave the flash drive in the printer after leaving the initial USB menu screen, then access held
jobs from the printer control panel to print files from the flash drive.
Supported flash drives and file types
Notes:
Highspeed USB flash drives must support the fullspeed standard. Low-speed USB devices are not
supported.
USB flash drives must support the File Allocation Table (FAT) system. Devices formatted with New
Technology File System (NTFS) or any other file system are not supported.
Recommended flash drives File type
Lexar JumpDrive FireFly (512MB and 1GB)
SanDisk Cruzer Micro (512MB and 1GB)
Sony Micro Vault Classic (512MB and 1GB)
Documents:
.pdf
.xps
Images:
.dcx
.gif
.jpeg or .jpg
.bmp
.pcx
.ti
or .tif
.png
.fls
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 68
background
Printing from a mobile device
Notes:
Make sure that the printer and mobile device share the same wireless network. For more information on
configuring the wireless settings of your mobile device, see the documentation that came with the
device.
Mobile printing is available only in some printer models.
Printing from a mobile device using Mopria Print Service
Mopria® Print Service is a mobile printing solution for mobile devices running on Android version 4.4 or later. It
allows you to print directly to any Mopriacertified printer.
Note: Before printing, make sure that the Mopria Print Service is enabled.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch a compatible application.
2 Tap Print, and then select the printer.
3 Send the print job.
Printing from a mobile device using Google Cloud Print
Google Cloud Print
TM
is a mobile printing service that allows enabled applications on mobile devices to print
to any Google Cloud Printready printer.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch an enabled application.
2 Tap Print, and then select the printer.
3 Send the print job.
Printing from a mobile device using AirPrint
AirPrint is a mobile printing solution that allows you to print directly from Apple devices to an AirPrint
certified
printer.
Notes:
This application is supported only in some Apple devices.
This application is supported only in some printer models.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch a compatible application.
2 Select an item to print, and then tap the share icon.
3 Tap Print, and then select a printer.
4 Print the document.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 69
background
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Mobile Print
Lexmark Mobile Print allows you to send documents and images directly to a supported Lexmark printer.
1 Open the document, and then send or share the document to Lexmark Mobile Print.
Note: Some thirdparty applications may not support the send or share feature. For more information, see
the documentation that came with the application.
2 Select a printer.
3 Print the document.
Printing confidential and other held jobs
Storing print jobs in the printer
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Security > > Confidential Print > select the print job type
Print job type Description
Max Invalid PIN Limits the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered.
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name and
PIN are deleted.
Confidential Job Expiration Lets you hold print jobs in the computer until you enter the PIN from the
printer control panel.
Note: The PIN is set from the computer. It must be four digits, using the
numbers 0–9.
Repeat Job Expiration Lets you print and store print jobs in the printer memory for reprinting.
Verify Job Expiration Lets you print one copy of a print job while the printer holds the remaining
copies. It allows you to examine if the first copy is satisfactory. The print
job is automatically deleted from the printer memory once all copies are
printed.
Reserve Job Expiration Lets you store print jobs for printing at a later time. The print jobs are held
until deleted from the Held Jobs menu.
Notes:
Confidential,
Verify, Reserve, and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to
process additional held jobs.
You can set the printer to store print jobs in the printer memory until you start the print job from the
printer control panel.
All print jobs that can be initiated by the user at the printer are called held jobs.
2 Press .
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 70
background
Printing held jobs
1 From the document you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 Select the printer, and then do either of the following:
For Windows users, click Properties or Preferences, and then click Print and Hold.
For Macintosh users, select Print and Hold.
3 Select the print job type.
4 If necessary, assign a user name.
5 Send the print job.
6 From the printer home screen, select Held Jobs.
7 Send the print job.
Printing information pages
Printing a font sample list
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Reports > > Print Fonts
2 Press the up or down arrow button to select the font setting.
3 Press .
Note: The PPDS fonts appear only when the PPDS data stream is activated.
Printing a directory list
From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Reports > > Print Directory >
Note: The Print Directory menu item appears only when an optional
flash
memory or printer hard disk is
installed.
Canceling a print job
Canceling a print job from the printer control panel
1 From the printer control panel, press .
2 When a list of print jobs appears, select the job to cancel, and then press .
3 Press to go back to the home screen.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 71
background
Canceling a print job from the computer
For Windows users
1
Open the printers folder, and then select your printer.
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.
For Macintosh users
1
From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer.
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.
Managing your printer
Finding advanced networking and administrator information
This chapter covers basic administrative support tasks using the Embedded Web Server. For more advanced
system support tasks, see the Networking Guide on the Software and Documentation CD or the Embedded
Web Server — Security: Administrator's Guide on the Lexmark support Web site at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Accessing the remote control panel
The remote control panel on your computer screen lets you interact with the printer control panel, even when
you are not physically near the network printer. From your computer screen, you can view the printer status
and do print-related tasks you might normally do while standing at the network printer.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
Print a network setup page or menu settings page, and then locate the IP address in the TCP/IP
section. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as
123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Press Enter to open the Web page of your printer.
3 Click Applications.
Note: The remote control panel requires a Java plugin to launch.
Configuring supply notifications from the Embedded Web Server
You can determine how you would like to be notified when supplies run nearly low, low, very low, or reach their
endoflife by setting the selectable alerts.
Notes:
Selectable alerts can be set on the toner cartridge, imaging unit, and maintenance kit.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 72
background
All selectable alerts can be set for nearly low, low, and very low supply conditions. Not all selectable
alerts can be set for the endoflife supply condition. Email selectable alert is available for all supply
conditions.
The percentage of estimated remaining supply that prompts the alert can be set on some supplies for
some supply conditions.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Supply Notifications.
3 From the dropdown menu for each supply, select one of the following notification options:
Notification Description
O The normal printer behavior for all supplies occurs.
Email Only The printer generates an email when the supply condition is reached. The status of
the supply appears on the menus page and status page.
Warning The printer displays the warning message and generates an email about the status
of the supply. The printer does not stop when the supply condition is reached.
Continuable Stop
1
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached, and the user
needs to press a button to continue printing.
Non Continuable Stop
1,2
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached. The supply
must be replaced to continue printing.
1
The printer generates an e-mail about the status of the supply when supply notification is enabled.
2
The printer stops when some supplies become empty to prevent damage.
4 Click Submit.
Modifying confidential print settings
Note: This feature is available only in network printers or printers connected to print servers.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings tab > Security > Confidential Print Setup.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 73
background
3 Modify the settings:
Set a maximum number of PIN entry attempts. When a user exceeds a specific number of PIN entry
attempts, all of the jobs for that user are deleted.
Set an expiration time for
confidential
print jobs. When a user has not printed the jobs within the
specified
time, all of the jobs for that user are deleted.
4 Save the modified settings.
Copying printer settings to other printers
Note: This feature is available only in network printers.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click the Copy Printer Settings.
3 To change the language, select a language from the drop-down menu, and then click Click here to submit
language.
4 Click Printer Settings.
5 Type the IP addresses of the source and target printers in their appropriate
fields.
Note: If you want to add or remove a target printer, then click Add Target IP or Remove Target IP.
6 Click Copy Printer Settings.
Printing a menu settings page
Print a menu settings page to review the current menu settings and to verify if the printer options are installed
correctly.
Note: If you have not changed any menu settings, then the menu settings page lists all the factory default
settings. When you select and save other settings from the menus, they replace the factory default settings
as user default settings. A user default setting remains in eect until you access the menu again, choose
another value, and save it.
From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Reports > > Menu Settings Page >
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 74
background
Printing a network setup page
If the printer is attached to a network, then print a network setup page to verify the network connection. This
page also provides important information that aids network printing configuration.
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Reports > > Network Setup Page >
2 Check the first section of the network setup page, and then confirm that the status is Connected.
If the status is Not Connected, then the LAN drop may not be active, or the network cable may be
malfunctioning. Consult your system support person for a solution, and then print another network setup
page.
Checking the status of parts and supplies
Notes:
Each gauge shows the estimated life left for the supply or part.
All page life estimates for supplies assume printing on a single side of a letter or A4size plain paper.
Checking the status of parts and supplies on the printer control panel
From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Status/Supplies > View Supplies >
Checking the status of parts and supplies from the Embedded Web Server
Note: Make sure the computer and printer are connected to the same network.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Device Status > More Details.
Saving energy
Using EcoMode
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 75
background
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > General Settings > EcoMode.
3 Select a setting.
Use To
O Use the factory default settings for all settings associated with EcoMode.
Notes:
Settings that were changed when other modes were selected are reset to the factory
default settings.
O
supports the performance
specifications
of the printer.
Energy Reduce energy use, especially when the printer is idle.
Notes:
Printer engine motors do not start until a document is ready to print. You may notice a
short delay before the
first
page is printed.
The printer enters Sleep mode after one minute of inactivity.
The printer display is turned o when the printer is in Sleep mode.
Lights on the staple finisher and other optional finishers are turned o when the printer is
in Sleep mode.
Energy/Paper Use all the settings associated with Energy and Paper modes.
Plain Paper Enable the automatic twosided (duplex) printing feature.
4 Click Submit.
Reducing printer noise
Enable Quiet mode to reduce the printer noise.
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Settings > > General Settings > > Quiet Mode >
2 Select a setting.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 76
background
Use To
On Reduce printer noise.
Notes:
Print jobs process at a reduced speed.
Printer engine motors do not start until a
document is ready to print. There is a short delay
before the first page is printed.
The alarm control and cartridge alarm sounds are
turned o.
The printer ignores the Advance Start command.
O Use factory default settings.
Note: This setting supports the performance
specifications of the printer.
3 Press .
Adjusting Sleep mode
1 From the control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Settings > > General Settings > > Timeouts > > Sleep Mode >
2 In the Sleep Mode field, select the number of minutes the printer is idle before it enters Sleep mode.
3 Apply the changes.
Using Hibernate mode
Hibernate is an ultralowpower saving mode.
Notes:
Three days is the default amount of time before the printer enters Hibernate mode.
Make sure to wake the printer from Hibernate mode before sending a print job. A hard reset or a long
press of the Sleep button wakes the printer from Hibernate mode.
If the printer is in Hibernate mode, then the Embedded Web Server is disabled.
1 From the control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Settings > > General Settings >
2 Select Press Sleep Button or Press and Hold Sleep Button, and then press .
3 Press Hibernate > .
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 77
background
Restoring factory default settings
If you want to keep a list of the current menu settings for reference, then print a menu settings page before
restoring the factory default settings. For more information, see
“Printing a menu settings page” on page 74.
If you want a more comprehensive method of restoring the printer factory default settings, then perform the
Wipe All Settings option. For more information, see
“Erasing nonvolatile memory” on page 80.
Warning—Potential Damage: Restoring factory defaults returns most printer settings to the original factory
default settings. Exceptions include the display language, custom sizes and messages, and network/port
menu settings. All downloads stored in the RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in the flash memory or in the
printer hard disk are not aected.
From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Settings > > Settings > > General Settings > > Factory Defaults > > Restore Now
>
Securing the printer
Using the security lock feature
The printer is equipped with a security lock feature. When a lock compatible with most laptop computers is
attached, the printer is locked. When locked, the controller board shield and the controller board cannot be
removed. Attach a security lock to the printer in the location shown.
Statement of Volatility
Your printer contains various types of memory that can store device and network settings, and user data.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 78
background
Type of memory Description
Volatile memory Your printer uses standard random access memory
(RAM) to temporarily buer user data during simple print
jobs.
Non-volatile memory Your printer may use two forms of non-volatile memory:
EEPROM and NAND (flash memory). Both types are used
to store the operating system, device settings, network
information, bookmark settings, and embedded
solutions.
Hard disk memory Some printers have a hard disk drive installed. The printer
hard disk is designed for device-specific functionality.
This lets the device retain buered user data from
complex print jobs, as well as form data, and font data.
Erase the content of any installed printer memory in the following circumstances:
The printer is being decommissioned.
The printer hard disk is being replaced.
The printer is being moved to a dierent department or location.
The printer is being serviced by someone from outside your organization.
The printer is being removed from your premises for service.
The printer is being sold to another organization.
Disposing of a printer hard disk
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
In highsecurity environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that confidential data
stored in the printer hard disk cannot be accessed when the printer—or its hard disk—is removed from your
premises.
Degaussing—Flushes the hard disk with a magnetic field that erases stored data
Crushing—Physically compresses the hard disk to break component parts and render them unreadable
Milling—Physically shreds the hard disk into small metal bits
Note: Most data can be erased electronically, but the only way to guarantee that all data is completely
erased is to physically destroy each hard disk where data is stored.
Erasing volatile memory
The volatile memory (RAM) installed in your printer requires a power source to retain information. To erase the
buered data, turn o the printer.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 79
background
Erasing nonvolatile memory
Erase individual settings, device and network settings, security settings, and embedded solutions by following
these steps:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 on the keypad while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen
with the progress bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display.
3 Press the up or down arrow button until Wipe All Settings appears.
The printer will restart several times during this process.
Note: Wipe All Settings securely removes device settings, solutions, jobs, and passwords from the printer
memory.
4 Navigate to:
Back > Exit Config Menu
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Erasing printer hard disk memory
Notes:
Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
Configuring Erase Temporary Data Files in the printer menus lets you remove residual confidential
material left by print jobs by securely overwriting files that have been marked for deletion.
Using the printer control panel
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress
bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display.
3 Press the up or down arrow button until Wipe Disk appears, and then select one of the following:
Wipe disk (fast)—This lets you overwrite the disk with all zeroes in a single pass.
Wipe disk (secure)—This lets you overwrite the disk with random bit patterns several times, followed by
a verification pass. A secure overwrite is compliant with the DoD 5220.22M standard for securely
erasing data from a hard disk. Highly confidential information should be wiped using this method.
4 Press the up or down arrow button until Yes appears, and then proceed with disk wiping.
Notes:
A status bar will indicate the progress of the disk wiping task.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 80
background
Disk wiping can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
5 Navigate to:
Back > Exit Config Menu
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Configuring printer hard disk encryption
Enable hard disk encryption to prevent loss of sensitive data in the event the printer or its hard disk is stolen.
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Security > Disk Encryption.
Note: Disk Encryption appears in the Security menu only when a formatted, nondefective printer hard
disk is installed.
3 From the Disk Encryption menu, select Enable.
Notes:
Enabling disk encryption will erase the content of the printer hard disk.
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
Using the printer control panel
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress
bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the
Configuration
menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display.
3 Navigate to:
Disk Encryption > Enable
Note: Enabling disk encryption will erase the contents of the printer hard disk.
4 Select Yes to proceed with disk wiping.
Notes:
Do not turn o the printer during the encryption process. Doing so may result in loss of data.
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 81
background
A status bar will indicate the progress of the disk wiping task. After the disk has been encrypted, the
printer will return to the screen for enabling or disabling disk encryption.
5 Navigate to:
Back > Exit Config Menu
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Finding printer security information
In high-security environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that confidential data
stored in the printer cannot be accessed by unauthorized persons. For more information, visit the
Lexmark security Web page.
You can also see the Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide for additional information:
1 Go to www.lexmark.com, and then navigate to Support & Downloads > select your printer.
2 Click the Manuals tab, and then select Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide.
Using MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, MS818dn 82
background
Using MS810de
Learning about the printer
Printer
configurations
Basic model
1 Standard bin
2 Printer control panel
3 Multipurpose feeder
4 Standard 550sheet tray (Tray 1)
Fully configured model
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability.
You must use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you
purchased a printer with a similar configuration, then you may need additional furniture. For more
information, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Using MS810de 83
background
The following illustration shows the maximum number of optional finishers and trays that are supported by the
printer. For more information on other configurations, visit
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Hardware option Alternative hardware option
1 Staple finisher
Output expander
4bin mailbox
Staple, hole punch finisher
2 4bin mailbox
Staple finisher
Staple, hole punch finisher
Output expander
3 Caster base None
4 2100sheet tray None
5 550sheet tray 250sheet tray
6 250sheet tray 550sheet tray
7 4bin mailbox Output expander
8 Output expander 4bin mailbox
Using MS810de 84
background
The staple, hole punch finisher must not be combined with any other output options.
In a configuration with three optional finishers, the output expander and mailbox may be installed in any
order.
In a configuration with two optional finishers:
The staple finisher must always be on top.
The highcapacity output expander must always be at the bottom.
The output expander is the only option that can be placed on top of the highcapacity output expander.
When using optional trays:
Always use a caster base when the printer is configured with a 2100sheet tray.
The 2100sheet tray must always be at the bottom of a configuration.
A maximum of four optional trays may be configured with the printer.
The optional 250 and 550sheet trays may be installed in any order.
Using the printer control panel
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Use the To
1 Display
View the printer status.
Set up and operate the printer.
2 Home button Go to the home screen.
3 Sleep button Enable Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.
Do the following to wake the printer from Sleep Mode:
Press any hard button.
Pull out Tray 1 or load paper in the multipurpose feeder.
Open a door or cover.
Send a print job from the computer.
Perform a poweron reset with the main power switch.
Attach a device to the USB port on the printer.
4 Keypad Enter numbers, letters, or symbols.
5 Stop or Cancel button Stop all printer activity.
6 Indicator light Check the status of the printer.
Using MS810de 85
background
Use the To
7 USB port Connect a flash drive to the printer.
Note: Only the front USB port supports
flash
drives.
Understanding the colors of the Sleep button and indicator lights
The colors of the Sleep button and indicator lights on the printer control panel signify a certain printer status
or condition.
Indicator light Printer status
O The printer is o or in Hibernate mode.
Blinking green The printer is warming up, processing data, or printing.
Solid green The printer is on, but idle.
Blinking red The printer requires user intervention.
Sleep button light Printer status
O The printer is o, idle or in Ready state.
Solid amber The printer is in Sleep mode.
Blinking amber The printer is entering or waking from Hibernate mode.
Blinking amber for 0.1 second, then goes
completely o for 1.9 seconds in a slow,
pulsing pattern
The printer is in Hibernate mode.
Understanding the home screen
When the printer is turned on, the display shows a basic screen, referred to as the home screen. Use the home
screen buttons and icons to initiate an action.
Note: Your home screen may vary depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative
setup, and active embedded solutions.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Using MS810de 86
background
Tou ch To
1 Change Language Change the primary language of the printer.
2 Bookmarks Create, organize, and save a set of bookmarks (URLs) into a tree view of folders and
file links.
Note: The tree view does not include bookmarks created within Forms and
Favorites, and the ones in the tree are not usable in Forms and Favorites.
3 Held Jobs Display all current held jobs.
4 USB View, select, or print photos and documents from a flash drive.
Note: This icon appears only when you return to the home screen while a memory
card or flash drive is connected to the printer.
5 Menus Access printer menus.
Note: These menus are available only when the printer is in Ready state.
6 Status message bar
Show the current printer status such as Ready or Busy.
Show the status of printer supplies.
Show intervention messages and the instructions on how to clear them.
7 Status/Supplies
Show a printer warning or error message whenever the printer requires intervention
to continue processing.
View more information on the printer warning or message, and on how to clear it.
8 Tips View a contextsensitive help information.
These may also appear on the home screen:
Tou ch To
Search Held Jobs Search current held jobs.
Jobs by user Access print jobs saved by user.
Profiles and Apps Access profiles and applications.
Features
Feature Description
Attendance message alert
If an attendance message aects a function, then this icon appears and the
red indicator light blinks.
Warning
If an error condition occurs, then this icon appears.
Printer IP address
Example: 123.123.123.123
The IP address of your printer is located at the top left corner of the home
screen. You can use the IP address when accessing the Embedded Web
Server to view and remotely configure printer settings.
Using MS810de 87
background
Using the touch-screen buttons
Note: Your home screen may vary, depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative
setup, and active embedded solutions.
1
2
3
4
5
Tou ch th e To
1 Radio button Select or clear an item.
2 Up arrow Scroll up.
3 Down arrow Scroll down.
4 Accept button Save a setting.
5 Cancel button
Cancel an action or a selection.
Return to the previous screen.
Tou ch To
Return to the home screen.
Open a context-sensitive Help dialog on the printer control panel.
Scroll to the left.
Scroll to the right.
Using MS810de 88
background
Setting up and using the home screen applications
Notes:
Your home screen may vary depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative
setup, and active embedded applications. Some applications are supported only in some printer models.
There may be additional solutions and applications available for purchase. For more information, go to
www.lexmark.com or contact the place where you purchased the printer.
Finding the IP address of the computer
For Windows users
1
In the Run dialog box, type cmd to open the command prompt.
2 Type ipconfig, and then look for the IP address.
For Macintosh users
1
From System Preferences in the Apple menu, select Network.
2 Select your connection type, and then click Advanced > TCP/IP.
3 Look for the IP address.
Finding the IP address of the printer
Note: Make sure your printer is connected to a network or to a print server.
You can find the printer IP address:
From the top left corner of the printer home screen.
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu.
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then finding the TCP/IP section.
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
Accessing the Embedded Web Server
The Embedded Web Server is the printer Web page that lets you view and remotely configure printer settings
even when you are not physically near the printer.
1 Obtain the printer IP address:
From the printer control panel home screen
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then
finding
the TCP/IP section
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
3 Press Enter.
Note: If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
Using MS810de 89
background
Customizing the home screen
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Do one or more of the following:
Show or hide the icons of basic printer functions.
a Click Settings > General Settings > Home screen customization.
b Select the check boxes to specify which icons appear on the home screen.
Note: If you clear a check box beside an icon, then the icon does not appear on the home
screen.
c Click Submit.
Customize the icon for an application. For more information, see “Finding information about the home
screen applications” on page 90 or see the documentation that came with the application.
Activating the home screen applications
Finding information about the home screen applications
Your printer comes with preinstalled home screen applications. Before you can use these applications, you
must first activate and set up these applications using the Embedded Web Server. For more information on
accessing the Embedded Web Server, see
Accessing the Embedded Web Server” on page 89.
For more information on configuring and using the home screen applications, do the following:
1 Go to http://support.lexmark.com.
2 Click Software Solutions, and then select either of the following:
Scan to Network—This lets you find information about the Scan to Network application.
Other Applications—This lets you find information about the other applications.
3 Click the Manuals tab, and then select the document for the home screen application.
Using Background and Idle Screen
Icon Description
The application lets you customize the background and idle screen of your printer home screen.
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
Change Background > select background to use
2 To uc h .
Using MS810de 90
background
Setting up Forms and Favorites
Note: A later version of this User's Guide may contain a direct link to the Administrator’s Guide of this
application. To check for updates of this User’s Guide, go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
Use To
Streamline work processes by letting you quickly find and print frequently used online forms
directly from the printer home screen.
Note: The printer must have permission to access the network folder, FTP site, or Web site
where the bookmark is stored. From the computer where the bookmark is stored, use sharing,
security, and firewall settings to allow the printer at least a read access. For help, see the
documentation that came with your operating system.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > Forms and Favorites.
3 Click Add, and then customize the settings.
Notes:
See the mouse-over help beside each field for a description of the setting.
To make sure the location settings of the bookmark are correct, type the correct IP address of the
host computer where the bookmark is located. For more information on obtaining the IP address of
the host computer, see “Finding the IP address of the computer” on page 89.
Make sure the printer has access rights to the folder where the bookmark is located.
4 Click Apply.
To use the application, touch Forms and Favorites on the printer home screen, and then navigate through form
categories, or search for forms based on a form number, name, or description.
Understanding EcoSettings
Icon Description
The application lets you easily manage energy consumption, noise, toner, and paper usage
settings to help reduce the environmental impact of your printer.
Using MS810de 91
background
Exporting and importing a configuration
You can export configuration settings into a text file, and then import the file to apply the settings to other
printers.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 To export or import a
configuration
for one application, do the following:
a Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management.
b From the list of installed applications, click the name of the application you want to configure.
c Click
Configure
, and then do either of the following:
To export a
configuration
to a
file,
click Export, and then follow the instructions on the computer
screen to save the configuration file.
Notes:
When saving the
configuration
file,
you can type a unique
file
name or use the default name.
If a "JVM Out of Memory” error occurs, then repeat the export process until the configuration
file is saved.
To import a configuration from a file, click Import, and then browse to the saved configuration file
that was exported from a previously
configured
printer.
Notes:
Before importing the configuration file, you can choose to preview it first or load it directly.
If a timeout occurs and a blank screen appears, then refresh the Web browser, and then click
Apply.
3 To export or import a configuration for multiple applications, do the following:
a Click Settings > Import/Export.
b Do either of the following:
To export a configuration file, click Export Embedded Solutions Settings File, and then follow the
instructions on the computer screen to save the configuration file.
To import a configuration file, do the following:
1 Click Import Embedded Solutions Settings File > Choose File, and then browse to the saved
configuration file that was exported from a previously configured printer.
2 Click Submit.
Setting up Remote Operator Panel
This application enables you to interact with the printer control panel even when you are not physically near
the network printer. From your computer, you can view the printer status, release held print jobs, create
bookmarks, and do other print-related tasks.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Click Settings > Remote Operator Panel Settings.
Using MS810de 92
background
3 Select the Enable check box, and then customize the settings.
4 Click Submit.
To use the application, click Remote Operator Panel > Launch VNC Applet.
Loading paper and specialty media
The selection and handling of paper and specialty media can aect how reliably documents print. For more
information, see
Avoiding jams” on page 263 and “Storing paper” on page 182.
Setting the paper size and type
From the home screen navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Paper Size/Type > select a tray > select the paper size or type >
Configuring
Universal paper settings
The Universal paper size is a userdefined setting that lets you print on paper sizes that are not preset in the
printer menus.
Notes:
The smallest supported Universal size is 70 x 127 mm (2.76 x 5 inches) for onesided printing and 105 x
148 mm (4.13 x 5.83 inches) for twosided (duplex) printing.
The largest supported Universal size is 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches) for onesided and twosided
printing.
When printing on paper less than 210 mm (8.3 inches) wide, the printer may print at a reduced speed
after a period of time to ensure the best print performance.
If you regularly print large jobs on narrow paper, then you may use the MS710 Series printer models,
which print batches of 10 or more pages of narrow paper at a faster speed. For more information on the
MS710 Series printer models, contact your Lexmark sales representative.
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Universal Setup > Units of Measure > select a unit of measure
2 To uc h Portrait Width or Portrait Height.
3 Select the width or height, and then touch .
Loading the 250 or 550sheet tray
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Pull out the tray.
Notes:
When loading folio, legal, or Oficiosize paper, lift the tray slightly and pull it out completely.
Using MS810de 93
background
Do not remove trays while a job prints or while Busy appears on the display. Doing so may cause a
jam.
2 Squeeze and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until it clicks
into place.
Note: Use the paper size indicators at the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.
Using MS810de 94
background
3 Unlock the length guide, and then squeeze and slide the guide to the correct position for the size of the
paper being loaded.
Notes:
Lock the length guide for all paper sizes.
Use the paper size indicators at the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.
Using MS810de 95
background
4 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten
the edges on a level surface.
5 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.
Note: Make sure the paper or envelope is loaded properly.
There are dierent ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is
installed or not.
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing Onesided printing
Using MS810de 96
background
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Twosided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple
finisher,
then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Do not slide the paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.
Using MS810de 97
background
If you are loading envelopes, then make sure that the flap side is facing up and the envelopes are on
the left side of the tray.
Make sure the paper is below the solid line, which is the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage:
Overfilling
the tray can cause paper jams.
Using MS810de 98
background
When using card stock, labels, or other types of specialty media, make sure the paper is below the
dashed line, which is the alternate paper
fill
indicator.
6 For custom or Universalsize paper, adjust the paper guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack, and then
lock the length guide.
7 Insert the tray.
8 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and paper type in the Paper menu to match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Using MS810de 99
background
Loading the 2100sheet tray
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Pull out the tray.
2 Adjust the width and length guides.
Loading A5size paper
a
Pull up and slide the width guide to the position for A5.
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A
4
A
5
1
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A
4
A
5
2
L
GL
O
F
C
FOL
IO
LTR
A
4
A
5
Using MS810de 100
background
b Squeeze and slide the length guide to the position for A5 until it clicks into place.
1
2
c Remove the A5 length guide from its holder.
1
2
d Insert the A5 length guide into its designated slot.
Note: Press the A5 length guide until it clicks into place.
Using MS810de 101
background
Loading A4, letter, legal, Oficio, and Foliosize paper
a
Pull up and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.
L
G
L
O
F
C
F
O
L
IO
L
T
R
A
4
A
5
1
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A4
A5
2
LG
L
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A4
A5
Using MS810de 102
background
b If the A5 length guide is still attached to the length guide, then remove it from its place. If the A5 length
guide is not attached, then proceed to step d.
c Put the A5 length guide in its holder.
2
1
Using MS810de 103
background
d Squeeze the length guide and slide it to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until
it clicks into place.
3 Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
4 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.
Note: Make sure the paper is loaded properly.
There are
dierent
ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple
finisher
is
installed or not.
Using MS810de 104
background
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS810de 105
background
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the tray can cause paper jams.
5 Insert the tray.
Note: Press the paper stack down while inserting the tray.
Using MS810de 106
background
6 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in
the tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Loading the multipurpose feeder
1 Pull down the multipurpose feeder door.
Note: Do not load or close the multipurpose feeder while a job is printing.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A4 A5
LTR
Using MS810de 107
background
2 Pull the multipurpose feeder extender.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A
4
A
5
L
T
R
Note: Guide the extender gently so that the multipurpose feeder is fully extended and open.
3 Slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.
B5
EXEC
A
4
A
5
LT R
Note: Use the paper size indicators on the bottom of tray to help position the guides.
Using MS810de 108
background
B
5
E
X
E
C
A4 A5
LTR
4 Prepare the paper or specialty media for loading.
Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Hold transparencies by the edges, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Note: Avoid touching the printable side of the transparencies. Be careful not to scratch them.
Flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on
a level surface.
5 Load the paper or specialty media.
Note: Slide the stack gently into the multipurpose feeder until it comes to a stop.
Load only one size and type of paper or specialty media at a time.
Make sure the paper fits loosely in the multipurpose feeder, lies flat, and is not bent or wrinkled.
Using MS810de 109
background
There are dierent ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is
installed or not.
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple
finisher,
then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS810de 110
background
Load envelopes with the flap side down and on the left of the multipurpose feeder.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A
4
A
5
LT
R
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated
linings, or selfstick adhesives. These envelopes may severely damage the printer.
Make sure the paper or specialty media is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the feeder can cause paper jams.
6 For custom- or Universal-size paper, adjust the width guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack.
7 From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper menu to match
the paper loaded in the tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Using MS810de 111
background
Linking and unlinking trays
Linking and unlinking trays
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu.
3 Change the paper size and type settings for the trays you are linking.
To link trays, make sure the paper size and type for the tray match that of the other tray.
To unlink trays, make sure the paper size or type for the tray does not match that of the other tray.
4 Click Submit.
Note: You can also change the paper size and type settings using the printer control panel. For more
information, see
“Setting the paper size and type” on page 93.
Warning—Potential Damage: Paper loaded in the tray should match the paper type name assigned in the
printer. The temperature of the fuser varies according to the
specified
paper type. Printing issues may occur
if settings are not properly configured.
Creating a custom name for a paper type
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Names.
3 Select a custom name, and then type a custom paper type name.
4 Click Submit.
5 Click Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Custom Names
2 Select a custom name, and then type a custom paper type name.
Using MS810de 112
background
3 Touch .
4 Touch Custom Types, and then verify that the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.
Assigning a custom paper type
Using the Embedded Web Server
Assign a custom paper type name to a tray when linking or unlinking trays.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Types.
3 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.
4 Click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Custom Types
2 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.
3 Touch .
Printing
Printing a document
Printing from a computer
Note: For labels, card stock, and envelopes, set the paper size and type in the printer before printing the
document.
1 From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 If necessary, adjust the settings.
3 Print the document.
Using MS810de 113
background
Printing forms
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
Forms and Favorites > select form > Print
2 If necessary, configure the print settings.
3 Send the print job.
Adjusting toner darkness
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Toner Darkness.
3 Adjust the setting, and then click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Ton er Darkness
2 Adjust the setting, and then touch .
Using MS810de 114
background
Printing from a flash drive
Printing from a flash drive
Notes:
Before printing an encrypted PDF file, you will be prompted to type the file password from the printer
control panel.
You cannot print files for which you do not have printing permissions.
1 Insert a flash drive into the USB port.
Notes:
A flash drive icon appears on the printer home screen when a flash drive is inserted.
If you insert the flash drive when the printer requires attention, such as when a jam has occurred,
then the printer ignores the flash drive.
If you insert the flash drive while the printer is processing other print jobs, then Busy appears. After
these print jobs are processed, you may need to view the held jobs list to print documents from the
flash drive.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the printer or the flash drive in the area shown while actively
printing, reading, or writing from the memory device. Loss of data can occur.
Using MS810de 115
background
2 From the printer control panel, touch the document you want to print.
3 Touch the arrows to specify the number of copies for printing, and then touch Print.
Notes:
Do not remove the flash drive from the USB port until the document has finished printing.
If you leave the flash drive in the printer after leaving the initial USB menu screen, then touch Held
Jobs on the home screen to print files from the flash drive.
Supported flash drives and file types
Notes:
Highspeed USB flash drives must support the fullspeed standard. Low-speed USB devices are not
supported.
USB flash drives must support the File Allocation Table (FAT) system. Devices formatted with New
Technology File System (NTFS) or any other file system are not supported.
Recommended flash drives File type
Lexar JumpDrive FireFly (512MB and 1GB)
SanDisk Cruzer Micro (512MB and 1GB)
Sony Micro Vault Classic (512MB and 1GB)
Documents:
.pdf
.xps
Images:
.dcx
.gif
.jpeg or .jpg
.bmp
.pcx
.ti
or .tif
.png
.fls
Using MS810de 116
background
Printing from a mobile device
Note: Make sure that the printer and mobile device share the same wireless network. For information on
configuring
the wireless settings of your mobile device, see the documentation that came with the device.
Printing from a mobile device using Mopria Print Service
Mopria® Print Service is a mobile printing solution for mobile devices running on Android version 4.4 or later. It
allows you to print directly to any Mopriacertified printer.
Note: Before printing, make sure that the Mopria Print Service is enabled.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch a compatible application.
2 Tap Print, and then select a printer.
3 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device using Google Cloud Print
Google Cloud Print is a mobile printing service that allows enabled applications on mobile devices to print to
any Google Cloud Printready printer.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch an enabled application.
2 Tap Print, and then select a printer.
3 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device using AirPrint
AirPrint is a mobile printing solution that allows you to print directly from Apple devices to an AirPrintcertified
printer.
Note: This application is supported only in some Apple devices.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch a compatible application.
2 Select an item to print, and then tap the share icon.
3 Tap Print, and then select the printer.
4 Send the print job.
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Print
Lexmark Print allows you to send documents and images directly to a Lexmark device.
1 Open the document, and then send or share the document to Lexmark Print.
Note: Some thirdparty applications may not support the send or share feature. For more information, see
the documentation that came with the application.
2 Select a device.
3 Print the document.
Using MS810de 117
background
Printing confidential and other held jobs
Storing print jobs in the printer
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Security >
Confidential
Print > select a print job type
Use To
Max Invalid PIN Limit the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered.
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name and
PIN are deleted.
Confidential Job Expiration Hold print jobs in the computer until you enter the PIN from the printer
control panel.
Note: The PIN is set from the computer. It must be four digits, using the
numbers 0–9.
Repeat Job Expiration Print and store print jobs in the printer memory.
Verify Job Expiration Print one copy of a print job and hold the remaining copies. It lets you
examine if the first copy is satisfactory or not. The print job is
automatically deleted from the printer memory when all copies are
printed.
Reserve Job Expiration Store print jobs for printing at a later time.
Note: The print jobs are held until deleted from the Held Jobs menu.
Notes:
Confidential, Verify, Reserve, and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to
process additional held jobs.
You can set the printer to store print jobs in the printer memory until you start the print job from the
printer control panel.
All print jobs that can be initiated by the user at the printer are called held jobs.
2 To uc h .
Printing held jobs
1 From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 Select the printer, and then do either of the following:
For Windows users, click Properties or Preferences, and then click Print and Hold.
For Macintosh users, select Print and Hold.
3 Select the print job type.
4 If necessary, assign a user name.
5 Send the print job.
6 From the printer home screen, touch Held Jobs.
7 Send the print job.
Using MS810de 118
background
Printing information pages
Printing a font sample list
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Print Fonts
2 To uc h PCL Fonts or PostScript Fonts.
Printing a directory list
A directory list shows the resources stored in a
flash
memory or in the printer hard disk.
From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Print Directory
Canceling a print job
Canceling a print job from the printer control panel
1 From the home screen, touch Cancel Jobs, or press on the keypad.
2 Touch the job you want to cancel, and then touch .
3 Press on the keypad to return to the home screen.
Canceling a print job from the computer
For Windows users
1
Open the printers folder, and then select your printer.
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.
For Macintosh users
1
From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer.
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.
Using MS810de 119
background
Managing your printer
Finding advanced networking and administrator information
This chapter covers basic administrative support tasks using the Embedded Web Server. For more advanced
system support tasks, see the Networking Guide on the Software and Documentation CD or the Embedded
Web Server — Security: Administrator's Guide on the Lexmark support Web site at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Checking the virtual display
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Check the virtual display that appears at the top left corner of the screen.
The virtual display works as an actual display would work on a printer control panel.
Configuring supply notifications from the Embedded Web Server
You can determine how you would like to be notified when supplies run nearly low, low, very low, or reach their
endoflife by setting the selectable alerts.
Notes:
Selectable alerts can be set on the toner cartridge, imaging unit, and maintenance kit.
All selectable alerts can be set for nearly low, low, and very low supply conditions. Not all selectable
alerts can be set for the endoflife supply condition. Email selectable alert is available for all supply
conditions.
The percentage of estimated remaining supply that prompts the alert can be set on some supplies for
some supply conditions.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Supply Notifications.
3 From the dropdown menu for each supply, select one of the following notification options:
Notification Description
O The normal printer behavior for all supplies occurs.
Email Only The printer generates an email when the supply condition is reached. The status of
the supply appears on the menus page and status page.
Using MS810de 120
background
Notification Description
Warning The printer displays the warning message and generates an email about the status
of the supply. The printer does not stop when the supply condition is reached.
Continuable Stop
1
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached, and the user
needs to press a button to continue printing.
Non Continuable Stop
1,2
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached. The supply
must be replaced to continue printing.
1
The printer generates an e-mail about the status of the supply when supply notification is enabled.
2
The printer stops when some supplies become empty to prevent damage.
4 Click Submit.
Modifying
confidential
print settings
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Security >
Confidential
Print Setup.
3 Modify the settings:
Set a maximum number of PIN entry attempts. When a user exceeds that number, all of the jobs for that
user are deleted.
Set an expiration time for
confidential
print jobs. When a user has not printed the jobs within that time,
all of the jobs for that user are deleted.
4 Click Submit to save the modified settings.
Copying printer settings to other printers
Note: This feature is available only in network printers.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Copy Printer Settings.
3 To change the language, select a language from the dropdown menu, and then click Click here to submit
language.
4 Click Printer Settings.
Using MS810de 121
background
5 Type the IP addresses of the source and target printers.
Note: If you want to add or remove target printers, then click Add Target IP or Remove Target IP.
6 Click Copy Printer Settings.
Printing a menu settings page
From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Menu Settings Page
Printing a network setup page
If the printer is attached to a network, then print a network setup page to verify the network connection. This
page also provides important information that aids network printing configuration.
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Network Setup Page
2 Check the first section of the network setup page and confirm that the status is Connected.
If the status is Not Connected, then the LAN drop may not be active, or the network cable may be
malfunctioning. Consult your system support person for a solution, and then print another network setup
page.
Checking the status of parts and supplies
Notes:
Each gauge shows the estimated life left for the supply or part.
All page life estimates for supplies assume printing on a single side of a letter or A4size plain paper.
Checking the status of parts and supplies on the printer control panel
From the home screen, touch Status/Supplies > View Supplies.
Checking the status of parts and supplies from the Embedded Web Server
Note: Make sure the computer and the printer are connected to the same network.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Device Status > More Details.
Using MS810de 122
background
Saving energy
Using EcoMode
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > General Settings > EcoMode.
3 Select a setting.
Use To
O Use the factory default settings for all settings associated with EcoMode.
Notes:
Settings that were changed when other modes were selected are reset to the factory
default settings.
O
supports the performance
specifications
of the printer.
Energy Reduce energy use, especially when the printer is idle.
Notes:
Printer engine motors do not start until a document is ready to print. You may notice a
short delay before the
first
page is printed.
The printer enters Sleep mode after one minute of inactivity.
The printer display is turned o when the printer is in Sleep mode.
Lights on the staple
finisher
and other optional
finishers
are turned
o
when the printer is
in Sleep mode.
Energy/Paper Use all the settings associated with Energy and Paper modes.
Plain Paper Enable the automatic twosided (duplex) printing feature.
4 Click Submit.
Reducing printer noise
Enable Quiet mode to reduce printer noise.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > General Settings > Quiet Mode.
3 Select a setting.
Using MS810de 123
background
Use To
On Reduce printer noise.
Notes:
Print jobs process at a reduced speed.
Printer engine motors do not start until a
document is ready to print. There is a short delay
before the first page is printed.
The alarm control and cartridge alarm sounds are
turned o.
The printer ignores the Advance Start command.
O Use factory default settings.
Note: This setting supports the performance
specifications of the printer.
4 Click Submit.
Adjusting Sleep mode
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > General Settings > Timeouts > Sleep Mode
2 In the Sleep Mode field, select the number of minutes the printer is idle before it enters Sleep mode.
3 Apply the changes.
Using Hibernate mode
Hibernate is an ultralowpower saving mode.
Notes:
Three days is the default amount of time before the printer enters Hibernate mode.
Make sure to wake the printer from Hibernate mode before sending a print job. A hard reset or a long
press of the Sleep button wakes the printer from Hibernate mode.
If the printer is in Hibernate mode, then the Embedded Web Server is disabled.
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > General Settings
2 To uc h Press Sleep Button or Press and Hold Sleep Button.
3 Touch Hibernate > .
Restoring factory default settings
If you want to keep a list of the current menu settings for reference, then print a menu settings page before
restoring the factory default settings. For more information, see
“Printing a menu settings page” on page 122.
Using MS810de 124
background
If you want a more comprehensive method of restoring the printer factory default settings, then perform the
Wipe All Settings option. For more information, see
“Erasing nonvolatile memory” on page 127.
Warning—Potential Damage: Restoring factory defaults returns most printer settings to the original factory
default settings. Exceptions include the display language, custom sizes and messages, and network/port
menu settings. All downloads stored in the RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in the flash memory or in a
printer hard disk are not aected.
From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > General Settings > Factory Defaults > Restore Now >
Securing the printer
Using the security lock feature
The printer is equipped with a security lock feature. When a lock compatible with most laptop computers is
attached, the printer is locked. When locked, the controller board shield and the controller board cannot be
removed. Attach a security lock to the printer in the location shown.
Statement of Volatility
Your printer contains various types of memory that can store device and network settings, and user data.
Using MS810de 125
background
Type of memory Description
Volatile memory Your printer uses standard random access memory
(RAM) to temporarily buer user data during simple print
jobs.
Non-volatile memory Your printer may use two forms of non-volatile memory:
EEPROM and NAND (flash memory). Both types are used
to store the operating system, device settings, network
information, bookmark settings, and embedded
solutions.
Hard disk memory Some printers have a hard disk drive installed. The printer
hard disk is designed for device-specific functionality.
This lets the device retain buered user data from
complex print jobs, as well as form data, and font data.
Erase the content of any installed printer memory in the following circumstances:
The printer is being decommissioned.
The printer hard disk is being replaced.
The printer is being moved to a dierent department or location.
The printer is being serviced by someone from outside your organization.
The printer is being removed from your premises for service.
The printer is being sold to another organization.
Disposing of a printer hard disk
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
In highsecurity environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that confidential data
stored in the printer hard disk cannot be accessed when the printer—or its hard disk—is removed from your
premises.
Degaussing—Flushes the hard disk with a magnetic field that erases stored data
Crushing—Physically compresses the hard disk to break component parts and render them unreadable
Milling—Physically shreds the hard disk into small metal bits
Note: Most data can be erased electronically, but the only way to guarantee that all data is completely
erased is to physically destroy each hard disk where data is stored.
Erasing volatile memory
The volatile memory (RAM) installed in your printer requires a power source to retain information. To erase the
buered data, simply turn o the printer.
Using MS810de 126
background
Erasing nonvolatile memory
Erase individual settings, device and network settings, security settings, and embedded solutions by following
these steps:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 on the keypad while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen
with the progress bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display instead of the standard home screen icons.
3 Touch Wipe All Settings.
The printer will restart several times during this process.
Note: Wipe All Settings securely removes device settings, solutions, jobs, and passwords from the printer
memory.
4 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Erasing printer hard disk memory
Notes:
Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
Configuring Erase Temporary Data Files in the printer menus lets you remove residual confidential
material left by print jobs by securely overwriting files that have been marked for deletion.
Using the printer control panel
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress
bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, the touch screen displays a list of functions.
3 Touch Wipe Disk, and then touch one of the following:
Wipe disk (fast)—This lets you overwrite the disk with all zeroes in a single pass.
Wipe disk (secure)—This lets you overwrite the disk with random bit patterns several times, followed by
a verification pass. A secure overwrite is compliant with the DoD 5220.22M standard for securely
erasing data from a hard disk. Highly
confidential
information should be wiped using this method.
4 Touch Ye s to proceed with disk wiping.
Notes:
A status bar will indicate the progress of the disk wiping task.
Disk wiping can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
5 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Using MS810de 127
background
Configuring printer hard disk encryption
Enable hard disk encryption to prevent loss of sensitive data in the event the printer or its hard disk is stolen.
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Security > Disk Encryption.
Note: Disk Encryption appears in the Security Menu only when a formatted, nondefective printer hard
disk is installed.
3 From the Disk encryption menu, select Enable.
Notes:
Enabling disk encryption will erase the contents of the printer hard disk.
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
4 Click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress
bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display.
3 Touch Disk Encryption > Enable.
Note: Enabling disk encryption will erase the contents of the printer hard disk.
4 Touch Ye s to proceed with disk wiping.
Notes:
Do not turn o the printer during the encryption process. Doing so may result in loss of data.
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
A status bar will indicate the progress of the disk wiping task. After the disk has been encrypted, the
printer will return to the Enable/Disable screen.
5 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Using MS810de 128
background
Finding printer security information
In high-security environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that
confidential
data
stored in the printer cannot be accessed by unauthorized persons. For more information, visit the
Lexmark security Web page.
You can also see the Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide for additional information:
1 Go to www.lexmark.com, and then navigate to Support & Downloads > select your printer.
2 Click the Manuals tab, and then select Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide.
Using MS810de 129
background
Using MS812de
Learning about the printer
Printer
configurations
Basic model
1 Standard bin
2 Printer control panel
3 Multipurpose feeder
4 Standard 550sheet tray (Tray 1)
Fully configured model
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted
configurations
require additional furniture for stability.
You must use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you
purchased a printer with a similar configuration, then you may need additional furniture. For more
information, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Using MS812de 130
background
The following illustration shows the maximum number of optional finishers and trays that are supported by the
printer. For more information on other configurations, visit
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Hardware option Alternative hardware option
1 Staple finisher
Output expander
4bin mailbox
Staple, hole punch finisher
2 4bin mailbox
Staple finisher
Staple, hole punch finisher
Output expander
3 Caster base None
4 2100sheet tray None
5 550sheet tray 250sheet tray
6 250sheet tray 550sheet tray
7 4bin mailbox Output expander
8 Output expander 4bin mailbox
Using MS812de 131
background
The staple, hole punch finisher must not be combined with any other output options.
In a configuration with three optional finishers, the output expander and mailbox may be installed in any
order.
In a configuration with two optional finishers:
The staple finisher must always be on top.
The highcapacity output expander must always be at the bottom.
The output expander is the only option that can be placed on top of the highcapacity output expander.
When using optional trays:
Always use a caster base when the printer is configured with a 2100sheet tray.
The 2100sheet tray must always be at the bottom of a configuration.
A maximum of four optional trays may be configured with the printer.
The optional 250 and 550sheet trays may be installed in any order.
Using the printer control panel
4
1
2
3
5
6
7
Use the To
1 Display
View the status of the printer.
Set up and operate the printer.
2 Home button Go to the home screen.
3 Sleep button Enable Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.
Do the following to wake the printer from Sleep mode:
Press and release the Sleep button.
Touch the screen or press any hard button.
Open a tray, cover, or door.
Send a print job from the computer.
Perform a poweron reset with the main power switch.
Attach a device to a USB port.
4 Keypad Enter numbers, letters, or symbols on the printer.
5 Stop or Cancel button Stop all printer activity.
6 Indicator light Check the status of the printer.
Using MS812de 132
background
Use the To
7 USB port Connect a USB Bluetooth adapter or a flash drive to the printer.
Note: Only the front USB port supports
flash
drives.
Understanding the colors of the Sleep button and indicator lights
The colors of the Sleep button and indicator lights on the printer control panel signify a certain printer status
or condition.
Indicator light Printer status
O The printer is o or in Hibernate mode.
Blinking green The printer is warming up, processing data, or printing.
Solid green The printer is on, but idle.
Blinking red The printer requires user intervention.
Sleep button light Printer status
O The printer is o, idle or in Ready state.
Solid amber The printer is in Sleep mode.
Blinking amber The printer is entering or waking from Hibernate mode.
Blinking amber for 0.1 second, then goes
completely o for 1.9 seconds in a slow,
pulsing pattern
The printer is in Hibernate mode.
Understanding the home screen
When the printer is turned on, the display shows a basic screen, referred to as the home screen. Use the home
screen buttons and icons to initiate an action.
Note: Your home screen may vary depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative
setup, and active embedded solutions.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Using MS812de 133
background
Tou ch To
1 Search Held Jobs Search current held jobs.
2 Held Jobs Display all current held jobs.
3 Forms and Favorites Access frequently used online forms.
4 EcoSettings Adjust energy consumption, noise, toner and paper usage.
5 Menus Access printer menus.
Note: These menus are available only when the printer is in Ready state.
6 Status message bar
Show the current printer status such as Ready or Busy.
Show printer conditions such as Imaging unit low or Cartridge Low.
Show intervention messages and the instructions on how to clear them.
7 Status/Supplies
Show a printer warning or error message whenever the printer requires
intervention to continue processing.
View more information on the printer warning or message, and on how to clear it.
8 Tips Open a contextsensitive Help information on the printer control panel.
Features
Feature Description
Attendance message alert
If an attendance message aects a function, then this icon appears and the
red indicator light blinks.
Warning
If an error condition occurs, then this icon appears.
Printer IP address
Example: 123.123.123.123
The IP address of your network printer is located at the top left corner of the
home screen and appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods. You
can use the IP address when accessing the Embedded Web Server so you can
view and remotely configure printer settings even when you are not physically
near the printer.
Using the touch-screen buttons
Note: Your home screen, icons, and buttons may vary, depending on your home screen customization
settings, administrative setup, and active embedded solutions.
Using MS812de 134
background
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Tou ch To
1 Left arrow
Scroll to the left.
2 Right arrow
Scroll to the right.
3 Up arrow
Scroll up.
4 Down arrow
Scroll down.
5Submit Submit changes made in the printer settings.
6Back Return to the previous screen.
7 Home
Return to the home screen.
8 Tips
Open a context-sensitive Help dialog on the printer control panel.
Using MS812de 135
background
Other touch-screen buttons
Tou ch To
Accept
Save settings.
Cancel
Cancel an action or a selection.
Leave a screen and return to the previous screen without saving changes.
Increase
Select a higher value.
Decrease
Select a lower value.
Exit
Leave the current screen.
Search
Search current held jobs.
Warning
View a warning or error message.
Using MS812de 136
background
Setting up and using the home screen applications
Notes:
Your home screen may vary depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative
setup, and active embedded applications. Some applications are supported only in some printer models.
There may be additional solutions and applications available for purchase. For more information, go to
www.lexmark.com or contact the place where you purchased the printer.
Finding the IP address of the computer
For Windows users
1
In the Run dialog box, type cmd to open the command prompt.
2 Type ipconfig, and then look for the IP address.
For Macintosh users
1
From System Preferences in the Apple menu, select Network.
2 Select your connection type, and then click Advanced > TCP/IP.
3 Look for the IP address.
Finding the IP address of the printer
Note: Make sure your printer is connected to a network or to a print server.
You can find the printer IP address:
From the top left corner of the printer home screen.
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu.
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then finding the TCP/IP section.
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
Accessing the Embedded Web Server
The Embedded Web Server is the printer Web page that lets you view and remotely configure printer settings
even when you are not physically near the printer.
1 Obtain the printer IP address:
From the printer control panel home screen
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then
finding
the TCP/IP section
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
3 Press Enter.
Note: If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
Using MS812de 137
background
Customizing the home screen
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Do one or more of the following:
Show or hide icons of basic printer functions.
a Click Settings > General Settings > Home screen customization.
b Select the check boxes to specify which icons appear on the printer home screen.
Note: If you clear a check box beside an icon, then the icon does not appear on the home
screen.
c Click Submit.
Customize the icon for an application. For more information, see “Finding information about the home
screen applications” on page 138 or see the documentation that came with the application.
Activating the home screen applications
Finding information about the home screen applications
Your printer comes with preinstalled home screen applications. Before you can use these applications, you
must first activate and set up these applications using the Embedded Web Server. For more information on
accessing the Embedded Web Server, see
Accessing the Embedded Web Server” on page 89.
For more information on configuring and using the home screen applications, do the following:
1 Go to http://support.lexmark.com.
2 Click Software Solutions, and then select either of the following:
Scan to Network—This lets you find information about the Scan to Network application.
Other Applications—This lets you find information about the other applications.
3 Click the Manuals tab, and then select the document for the home screen application.
Using Background and Idle Screen
Use To
Customize the background and idle screen of your printer home screen.
From the home screen, navigate to:
Change Background > select background to use > Apply
Using MS812de 138
background
Setting up Forms and Favorites
Note: A later version of this User's Guide may contain a direct link to the Administrator’s Guide of this
application. To check for updates of this User’s Guide, visit
http://support.lexmark.com.
Use To
Quickly find and print frequently used online forms directly from the printer home screen.
Note: The printer must have permission to access the network folder, FTP site, or Web site
where the bookmark is stored. From the computer where the bookmark is stored, use sharing,
security, and firewall settings to allow the printer at least a read access. For help, see the
documentation that came with your operating system.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > Forms and Favorites.
3 Click Add, and then customize the settings.
Notes:
See the mouse-over help beside each field for a description of the setting.
To make sure the location settings of the bookmark are correct, type the correct IP address of the
host computer where the bookmark is located. For more information on obtaining the IP address of
the host computer, see “Finding the IP address of the computer” on page 89.
Make sure the printer has access rights to the folder where the bookmark is located.
4 Click Apply.
To use the application, touch Forms and Favorites on the printer home screen, and then navigate through form
categories, or search for forms based on a form number, name, or description.
Understanding EcoSettings
Use To
Manage energy consumption, noise, toner, and paper usage settings to help reduce the
environmental impact of your printer.
Using MS812de 139
background
Exporting and importing a configuration
You can export configuration settings into a text file, and then import the file to apply the settings to other
printers.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 To export or import a
configuration
for one application, do the following:
a Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management.
b From the list of installed applications, click the name of the application you want to configure.
c Click
Configure
, and then do either of the following:
To export a
configuration
to a
file,
click Export, and then follow the instructions on the computer
screen to save the configuration file.
Notes:
When saving the
configuration
file,
you can type a unique
file
name or use the default name.
If a "JVM Out of Memory” error occurs, then repeat the export process until the configuration
file is saved.
To import a configuration from a file, click Import, and then browse to the saved configuration file
that was exported from a previously
configured
printer.
Notes:
Before importing the configuration file, you can choose to preview it first or load it directly.
If a timeout occurs and a blank screen appears, then refresh the Web browser, and then click
Apply.
3 To export or import a configuration for multiple applications, do the following:
a Click Settings > Import/Export.
b Do either of the following:
To export a configuration file, click Export Embedded Solutions Settings File, and then follow the
instructions on the computer screen to save the configuration file.
To import a configuration file, do the following:
1 Click Import Embedded Solutions Settings File > Choose File, and then browse to the saved
configuration file that was exported from a previously configured printer.
2 Click Submit.
Setting up Remote Operator Panel
This application enables you to interact with the printer control panel even when you are not physically near
the network printer. From your computer, you can view the printer status, release held print jobs, create
bookmarks, and do other print-related tasks.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
2 Click Settings > Remote Operator Panel Settings.
Using MS812de 140
background
3 Select the Enable check box, and then customize the settings.
4 Click Submit.
To use the application, click Remote Operator Panel > Launch VNC Applet.
Loading paper and specialty media
The selection and handling of paper and specialty media can aect how reliably documents print. For more
information, see
Avoiding jams” on page 263 and “Storing paper” on page 182.
Setting the paper size and type
From the home screen navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Paper Size/Type > select a tray > select a paper size or type > Submit
Notes:
The paper size is automatically set according to the position of the paper guides in each tray except the
multipurpose feeder.
The paper size for the multipurpose feeder must be set manually from the Paper Size menu.
The paper type must be set manually for all trays that do not contain plain paper.
Configuring Universal paper settings
Universal paper size is a userdefined setting that lets you print on paper sizes that are not preset in the printer
menus.
Notes:
The smallest supported Universal size is 70 x 127 mm (2.76 x 5 inches) for onesided printing and 105 x
148 mm (4.13 x 5.83 inches) for twosided (duplex) printing.
The largest supported Universal size is 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches) for onesided and twosided
printing.
When printing on paper less than 210 mm (8.3 inches) wide, the printer may print at a reduced speed
after a period of time to ensure the best print performance.
If you regularly print large jobs on narrow paper, then you may use the MS710 Series printer models,
which print batches of 10 or more pages of narrow paper at a faster speed. For more information on the
MS710 Series printer models, contact your Lexmark sales representative.
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Universal Setup > Units of Measure > select a unit of measure
2 To uc h Portrait Width or Portrait Height.
3 Select the width or height, and then touch Submit.
Using MS812de 141
background
Loading the 250 or 550sheet tray
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Pull out the tray.
Notes:
When loading folio, legal, or Oficiosize paper, lift the tray slightly and then pull it out completely.
Do not remove trays while a job prints or while Busy appears on the display. Doing so may cause a
jam.
Using MS812de 142
background
2 Squeeze and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until it clicks
into place.
Note: Use the paper size indicators at the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.
Using MS812de 143
background
3 Unlock the length guide, and then squeeze and slide the guide to the correct position for the size of the
paper being loaded.
Notes:
Lock the length guide for all paper sizes.
Use the paper size indicators at the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.
Using MS812de 144
background
4 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten
the edges on a level surface.
5 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.
Note: Make sure the paper or envelope is loaded properly.
There are dierent ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is
installed or not.
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS812de 145
background
Do not slide the paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.
If you are loading envelopes, then make sure that the flap side is facing up and the envelopes are on
the left side of the tray.
Using MS812de 146
background
Make sure the paper is below the solid line, which is the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage:
Overfilling
the tray can cause paper jams.
Using MS812de 147
background
When using card stock, labels, or other types of specialty media, make sure the paper is below the
dashed line, which is the alternate paper
fill
indicator.
6 For custom or Universalsize paper, adjust the paper guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack, and then
lock the length guide.
7 Insert the tray.
8 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and paper type in the Paper menu to match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Using MS812de 148
background
Loading the 2100sheet tray
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Pull out the tray.
2 Adjust the width and length guides.
Loading A5size paper
a
Pull up and slide the width guide to the position for A5.
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A
4
A
5
1
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A
4
A
5
2
L
GL
O
F
C
FOL
IO
LTR
A
4
A
5
Using MS812de 149
background
b Squeeze and slide the length guide to the position for A5 until it clicks into place.
1
2
c Remove the A5 length guide from its holder.
1
2
d Insert the A5 length guide into its designated slot.
Note: Press the A5 length guide until it clicks into place.
Using MS812de 150
background
Loading A4, letter, legal, oficio, and foliosize paper
a
Pull up and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.
L
G
L
O
F
C
F
O
L
IO
L
T
R
A
4
A
5
1
LGL
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A4
A5
2
LG
L
OFC
FOLIO
LTR
A4
A5
Using MS812de 151
background
b If the A5 length guide is still attached to the length guide, then remove it from its place. If the A5 length
guide is not attached, then proceed to step d.
c Put the A5 length guide in its holder.
2
1
Using MS812de 152
background
d Squeeze the length guide and slide it to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until
it clicks into place.
3 Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
4 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.
Note: Make sure the paper is loaded properly.
There are
dierent
ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple
finisher
is
installed or not.
Using MS812de 153
background
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS812de 154
background
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the tray can cause paper jams.
5 Insert the tray.
Note: Press the paper stack down while inserting the tray.
Using MS812de 155
background
6 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Loading the multipurpose feeder
1 Pull down the multipurpose feeder door.
Note: Do not load or close the multipurpose feeder while a job is printing.
B
5
EX
EC
A
4
A
5
LT
R
Using MS812de 156
background
2 Using the handle, pull the multipurpose feeder extender.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A
4
A
5
L
T
R
Note: Guide the extender gently so that the multipurpose feeder is fully extended and open.
3 Slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.
B5
EXEC
A
4
A
5
LT R
Note: Use the paper size indicators on the bottom of tray to help position the guides.
Using MS812de 157
background
B
5
E
X
E
C
A4 A5
LTR
4 Prepare the paper or specialty media for loading.
Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Hold transparencies by the edges, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Note: Avoid touching the printable side of the transparencies. Be careful not to scratch them.
Flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on
a level surface.
5 Load the paper or specialty media.
Note: Slide the stack gently into the multipurpose feeder until it comes to a stop.
Load only one size and type of paper or specialty media at a time.
Make sure the paper fits loosely in the multipurpose feeder, lies flat and is not bent or wrinkled.
Using MS812de 158
background
There are dierent ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is
installed or not.
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Onesided printing
ABC
Twosided printing
Twosided printing
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple
finisher,
then make sure the holes on the
long edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray.
Onesided printing Twosided printing
ABC
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.
Using MS812de 159
background
Load envelopes with the flap side down and on the left of the multipurpose feeder.
B
5
E
X
E
C
A
4
A
5
LT
R
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated
linings, or selfstick adhesives. These envelopes may severely damage the printer.
Make sure the paper or specialty media is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the feeder can cause paper jams.
6 For custom- or Universal-size paper, adjust the width guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack.
7 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in
the tray.
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.
Using MS812de 160
background
Linking and unlinking trays
Linking and unlinking trays
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu.
3 Change the paper size and type settings for the trays you are linking.
To link trays, make sure the paper size and type for the tray match that of the other tray.
To unlink trays, make sure the paper size or type for the tray does not match that of the other tray.
4 Click Submit.
Note: You can also change the paper size and type settings using the printer control panel. For more
information, see
“Setting the paper size and type” on page 141.
Warning—Potential Damage: Paper loaded in the tray should match the paper type name assigned in the
printer. The temperature of the fuser varies according to the
specified
paper type. Printing issues may occur
if settings are not properly configured.
Creating a custom name for a paper type
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Names.
3 Select a custom name, and then type a custom paper type name.
4 Click Submit.
5 Click Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Custom Names
2 Select a custom name, and then type a custom paper type name.
3 Touch Submit.
4 Touch Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.
Using MS812de 161
background
Assigning a custom paper type
Using the Embedded Web Server
Assign a custom paper type name to a tray when linking or unlinking trays.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Types.
3 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.
4 Click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Paper Menu > Custom Types
2 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.
3 Touch Submit.
Printing
Printing a document
Printing from a computer
Note: For specialty media such as labels, card stock, and envelopes, set the paper size and type in the
printer before sending the print job.
1 From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 If necessary, adjust the settings.
3 Send the print job.
Printing forms
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
Forms and Favorites > select form > Print
2 If necessary, configure the print settings.
Using MS812de 162
background
3 Send the print job.
Adjusting toner darkness
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Toner Darkness.
3 Adjust the toner darkness, and then click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Toner Darkness
2 Adjust the setting, and then touch Submit.
Printing from a flash drive
Printing from a flash drive
Notes:
Before printing an encrypted PDF file, you will be prompted to type the file password from the printer
control panel.
You cannot print files for which you do not have printing permissions.
1 Insert a flash drive into the USB port.
Notes:
A flash drive icon appears on the printer home screen when a flash drive is inserted.
Using MS812de 163
background
If you insert the flash drive when the printer requires attention, such as when a jam has occurred,
then the printer ignores the
flash
drive.
If you insert the
flash
drive while the printer is processing other print jobs, then Busy appears. After
these print jobs are processed, you may need to view the held jobs list to print documents from the
flash drive.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the USB cable, any wireless network adapter, any connector,
the memory device, or the printer in the areas shown while actively printing, reading, or writing from the
memory device. Loss of data can occur.
2 From the printer control panel, touch the document you want to print.
3 Touch the arrows to specify the number of copies for printing, and then touch Print.
Notes:
Do not remove the flash drive from the USB port until the document has finished printing.
If you leave the flash drive in the printer after leaving the initial USB menu screen, then touch Held
Jobs on the home screen to print files from the flash drive.
Supported flash drives and file types
Notes:
Highspeed USB flash drives must support the fullspeed standard. Low-speed USB devices are not
supported.
USB flash drives must support the File Allocation Table (FAT) system. Devices formatted with New
Technology File System (NTFS) or any other file system are not supported.
Using MS812de 164
background
Recommended flash drives File type
Lexar JumpDrive FireFly (512MB and 1GB)
SanDisk Cruzer Micro (512MB and 1GB)
Sony Micro Vault Classic (512MB and 1GB)
Documents:
.pdf
.xps
Images:
.dcx
.gif
.jpeg or .jpg
.bmp
.pcx
.ti or .tif
.png
.fls
Printing from a mobile device
Note: Make sure that the printer and mobile device share the same wireless network. For information on
configuring
the wireless settings of your mobile device, see the documentation that came with the device.
Printing from a mobile device using Mopria Print Service
Mopria® Print Service is a mobile printing solution for mobile devices running on Android version 4.4 or later. It
allows you to print directly to any Mopriacertified printer.
Note: Before printing, make sure that Mopria Print Service is enabled.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch a compatible application.
2 Tap Print, and then select the printer.
3 Send the print job.
Printing from a mobile device using Google Cloud Print
Google Cloud Print is a mobile printing service that allows enabled applications on mobile devices to print to
any Google Cloud Printready printer.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch an enabled application.
2 Tap Print, and then select the printer.
3 Send the print job.
Printing from a mobile device using AirPrint
AirPrint is a mobile printing solution that allows you to print directly from Apple devices to an AirPrintcertified
printer.
Using MS812de 165
background
Note: This application is supported only in some Apple devices.
1 From the home screen of your mobile device, launch a compatible application.
2 Select an item to print, and then tap the share icon.
3 Tap Print, and then select the printer.
4 Send the print job.
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Print
Lexmark Print allows you to send documents and images directly to a Lexmark device.
1 Open the document, and then send or share the document to Lexmark Print.
Note: Some thirdparty applications may not support the send or share feature. For more information, see
the documentation that came with the application.
2 Select a device.
3 Print the document.
Printing
confidential
and other held jobs
Storing print jobs in the printer
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
> Security > Confidential Print > select the print job type
Use To
Max Invalid PIN Limit the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered.
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name and
PIN are deleted.
Confidential Job Expiration Hold print jobs in the computer until you enter the PIN from the printer
control panel.
Note: The PIN is set from the computer. It must be four digits, using the
numbers 1–9.
Repeat Job Expiration Print and store print jobs in the printer memory.
Verify Job Expiration Print one copy of a print job and hold the remaining copies. It allows you
to examine if the first copy is satisfactory. The print job is automatically
deleted from the printer memory when all copies are printed.
Reserve Job Expiration Store print jobs for printing at a later time.
Note: The print jobs are held until deleted from the Held Jobs menu.
Using MS812de 166
background
Use To
Notes:
Confidential,
Verify, Reserve, and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to
process additional held jobs.
You can set the printer to store print jobs in the printer memory until you start the print job from the
printer control panel.
All print jobs that can be initiated by the user at the printer are called held jobs.
2 To uc h Submit.
Printing held jobs
1 From the document you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 Select the printer, and then do the following:
For Windows users, click Properties or Preferences, and then click Print and Hold.
For Macintosh users, select Print and Hold.
3 Select the print job type.
4 If necessary, assign a user name.
5 Send the print job.
6 From the printer home screen, touch Held Jobs.
7 Send the print job.
Printing information pages
Printing a font sample list
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Print Fonts
2 To uc h PCL Fonts or PostScript Fonts.
Printing a directory list
A directory list shows the resources stored in a
flash
memory or in the printer hard disk.
From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Print Directory
Using MS812de 167
background
Canceling a print job
Canceling a print job from the printer control panel
1 From the printer control panel, touch Cancel Job or press on the keypad.
2 Touch the print job you want to cancel, and then touch Delete Selected Jobs.
Note: If you press
on the keypad, then touch Resume to return to the home screen.
Canceling a print job from the computer
For Windows users
1
Open the printers folder, and then select your printer.
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.
For Macintosh users
1
From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer.
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.
Managing your printer
Finding advanced networking and administrator information
This chapter covers basic administrative support tasks using the Embedded Web Server. For more advanced
system support tasks, see the Networking Guide on the Software and Documentation CD or the Embedded
Web Server — Security: Administrator's Guide on the Lexmark support Web site at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Checking the virtual display
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Check the virtual display that appears in the top left corner of the screen.
The virtual display works as an actual display would work on a printer control panel.
Configuring supply notifications from the Embedded Web Server
You can determine how you would like to be notified when supplies run nearly low, low, very low, or reach their
endoflife by setting the selectable alerts.
Using MS812de 168
background
Notes:
Selectable alerts can be set on the toner cartridge, imaging unit, and maintenance kit.
All selectable alerts can be set for nearly low, low, and very low supply conditions. Not all selectable
alerts can be set for the endoflife supply condition. Email selectable alert is available for all supply
conditions.
The percentage of estimated remaining supply that prompts the alert can be set on some supplies for
some supply conditions.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Supply Notifications.
3 From the dropdown menu for each supply, select one of the following notification options:
Notification Description
O The normal printer behavior for all supplies occurs.
Email Only The printer generates an e-mail when the supply condition is reached. The status of
the supply will appear on the menus page and status page.
Warning The printer displays the warning message and generates an email about the status
of the supply. The printer does not stop when the supply condition is reached.
Continuable Stop
1
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached, and the user
needs to press a button to continue printing.
Non Continuable Stop
1,2
The printer stops when the supply condition is reached. The supply must be replaced
to continue printing.
1
The printer generates an e-mail about the status of the supply when supply notification is enabled.
2
The printer stops when some supplies become empty to prevent damage.
4 Click Submit.
Modifying
confidential
print settings
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Security >
Confidential
Print Setup.
Using MS812de 169
background
3 Modify the settings:
Set a maximum number of PIN entry attempts. When a user exceeds that number, all of the jobs for that
user are deleted.
Set an expiration time for
confidential
print jobs. When a user has not printed the jobs within that time,
all of the jobs for that user are deleted.
4 Click Submit to save the modified settings.
Copying printer settings to other printers
Note: This feature is available only in network printers.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Copy Printer Settings.
3 To change the language, select a language from the dropdown menu, and then click Click here to submit
language.
4 Click Printer Settings.
5 Type the IP addresses of the source and target printers.
Note: If you want to add or remove target printers, then click Add Target IP or Remove Target IP.
6 Click Copy Printer Settings.
Printing a menu settings page
From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Menu Settings Page
Printing a network setup page
If the printer is attached to a network, then print a network setup page to verify the network connection. This
page also provides important information that aids network printing configuration.
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Reports > Network Setup Page
2 Check the first section of the network setup page and confirm that the status is Connected.
If the status is Not Connected, then the LAN drop may not be active, or the network cable may be
malfunctioning. Consult your system support person for a solution, and then print another network setup
page.
Using MS812de 170
background
Checking the status of parts and supplies
A message appears on the printer display when a replacement supply item is needed or when maintenance is
required.
Notes:
Each gauge displays the estimated life left for the supply or part.
All page life estimates for supplies assume printing on a single side of letter or A4size plain paper.
Checking the status of parts and supplies on the printer control panel
From the home screen, navigate to:
Status/Supplies > View Supplies
Checking the status of parts and supplies from the Embedded Web Server
Note: Make sure that the computer and printer are connected to the same network.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Device Status > More Details.
Saving energy
Using EcoMode
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > General Settings > EcoMode.
3 Select a setting.
Using MS812de 171
background
Use To
O Use the factory default settings for all settings associated with EcoMode.
Notes:
Settings that were changed when other modes were selected are reset to the factory
default settings.
O supports the performance specifications of the printer.
Energy Reduce energy use, especially when the printer is idle.
Notes:
Printer engine motors do not start until a document is ready to print. You may notice a
short delay before the
first
page is printed.
The printer enters Sleep mode after one minute of inactivity.
The printer display is turned o when the printer is in Sleep mode.
Lights on the staple
finisher
and other optional
finishers
are turned
o
when the printer is
in Sleep mode.
Energy/Paper Use all the settings associated with Energy and Paper modes.
Plain Paper Enable the automatic twosided (duplex) printing feature.
4 Click Submit.
Reducing printer noise
Enable Quiet mode to reduce printer noise.
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > General Settings > Quiet Mode.
3 Select a setting.
Using MS812de 172
background
Use To
On Reduce printer noise.
Notes:
Print jobs process at a reduced speed.
Printer engine motors do not start until a
document is ready to print. There is a short delay
before the first page is printed.
The alarm control and cartridge alarm sounds are
turned o.
The printer will ignore the Advance Start
command.
O Use factory default settings.
Note: This setting supports the performance
specifications
of the printer.
4 Click Submit.
Adjusting Sleep mode
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > General Settings > Timeouts > Sleep Mode
2 In the Sleep Mode field, select the number of minutes the printer is idle before it enters Sleep mode.
3 Apply the changes.
Using Hibernate mode
Hibernate is an ultralowpower operating mode.
Notes:
Three days is the default amount of time before the printer enters Hibernate mode.
Make sure to wake the printer from Hibernate mode before sending a print job. A hard reset or a long
press of the Sleep button wakes the printer from Hibernate mode.
If the printer is in Hibernate mode, then the Embedded Web Server is disabled.
1 From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > General Settings
2 From the “Press Sleep Button” or “Press and Hold Sleep Button” menu, select Hibernate, and then touch
Submit.
Restoring factory default settings
If you want to keep a list of the current menu settings for reference, then print a menu settings page before
restoring the factory default settings. For more information, see
“Printing a menu settings page” on page 170.
Using MS812de 173
background
If you want a more comprehensive method of restoring the printer factory default settings, then perform the
Wipe All Settings option. For more information, see
“Erasing nonvolatile memory” on page 175.
Warning—Potential Damage: Restoring factory defaults returns most printer settings to the original factory
default settings. Exceptions include the display language, custom sizes and messages, and network/port
menu settings. All downloads stored in the RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in the flash memory or in a
printer hard disk are not aected.
From the home screen, navigate to:
> Settings > General Settings > Factory Defaults > Restore Now > Submit
Securing the printer
Using the security lock feature
The printer is equipped with a security lock feature. When a lock compatible with most laptop computers is
attached, the printer is locked. When locked, the controller board shield and the controller board cannot be
removed. Attach a security lock to the printer in the location shown.
Statement of Volatility
Your printer contains various types of memory that can store device and network settings, and user data.
Type of memory Description
Volatile memory Your printer uses standard random access memory (RAM)
to temporarily buer user data during simple print jobs.
Non-volatile memory Your printer may use two forms of non-volatile memory:
EEPROM and NAND (flash memory). Both types are used
to store the operating system, device settings, network
information, bookmark settings, and embedded
solutions.
Using MS812de 174
background
Type of memory Description
Hard disk memory Some printers have a hard disk drive installed. The printer
hard disk is designed for device-specific functionality.
This lets the device retain
buered
user data from
complex print jobs, as well as form data, and font data.
Erase the content of any installed printer memory in the following circumstances:
The printer is being decommissioned.
The printer hard disk is being replaced.
The printer is being moved to a dierent department or location.
The printer is being serviced by someone from outside your organization.
The printer is being removed from your premises for service.
The printer is being sold to another organization.
Disposing of a printer hard disk
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
In highsecurity environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that
confidential
data
stored in the printer hard disk cannot be accessed when the printer—or its hard disk—is removed from your
premises.
Degaussing—Flushes the hard disk with a magnetic field that erases stored data
Crushing—Physically compresses the hard disk to break component parts and render them unreadable
Milling—Physically shreds the hard disk into small metal bits
Note: Most data can be erased electronically, but the only way to guarantee that all data is completely
erased is to physically destroy each hard disk where data is stored.
Erasing volatile memory
The volatile memory (RAM) installed in your printer requires a power source to retain information. To erase the
buered data, simply turn o the printer.
Erasing nonvolatile memory
Erase individual settings, device and network settings, security settings, and embedded solutions by following
these steps:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress
bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display, instead of the standard home screen icons.
3 Touch Wipe All Settings.
The printer restarts several times during this process.
Note: Wipe All Settings securely removes device settings, solutions, jobs, and passwords from the printer
memory.
4 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.
Using MS812de 175
background
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Erasing printer hard disk memory
Notes:
Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
Configuring Erase Temporary Data Files in the printer menus lets you remove residual confidential
material left by print jobs by securely overwriting files that have been marked for deletion.
Using the printer control panel
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress
bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, the touch screen displays a list of functions.
3 Touch Wipe Disk, and then touch one of the following:
Wipe disk (fast)—This lets you overwrite the disk with all zeroes in a single pass.
Wipe disk (secure)—This lets you overwrite the disk with random bit patterns several times, followed by
a verification pass. A secure overwrite is compliant with the DoD 5220.22M standard for securely
erasing data from a hard disk. Highly confidential information should be wiped using this method.
4 Touch Ye s to proceed with disk wiping.
Notes:
A status bar will indicate the progress of the disk wiping task.
Disk wiping can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
5 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Configuring printer hard disk encryption
Enable hard disk encryption to prevent loss of sensitive data in the event the printer or its hard disk is stolen.
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
Using MS812de 176
background
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Security > Disk Encryption.
Note: Disk Encryption appears in the Security Menu only when a formatted, nondefective printer hard
disk is installed.
3 From the Disk encryption menu, select Enable.
Notes:
Enabling disk encryption will erase the contents of the printer hard disk.
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
4 Click Submit.
Using the printer control panel
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress
bar appears.
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is
fully turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display.
3 Touch Disk Encryption > Enable.
Note: Enabling disk encryption will erase the contents of the printer hard disk.
4 Touch Ye s to proceed with disk wiping.
Notes:
Do not turn o the printer during the encryption process. Doing so may result in loss of data.
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be
unavailable for other user tasks.
A status bar will indicate the progress of the disk wiping task. After the disk has been encrypted, the
printer will return to the Enable/Disable screen.
5 Touch Back > Exit
Config
Menu.
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.
Finding printer security information
In high-security environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that confidential data
stored in the printer cannot be accessed by unauthorized persons. For more information, visit the
Lexmark security Web page.
You can also see the Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide for additional information:
1 Go to www.lexmark.com, and then navigate to Support & Downloads > select your printer.
2 Click the Manuals tab, and then select Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide.
Using MS812de 177
background
Paper and specialty media guide
Notes:
Make sure that the paper size, type, and weight are set correctly on the computer or control panel.
Flex, fan, and straighten specialty media before loading them.
The printer may print at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the fuser.
For more information on card stock and labels, see the Card Stock & Label Guide at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Using specialty media
Tips on using card stock
Card stock is heavy, singleply specialty media. Many of its variable characteristics, such as moisture content,
thickness, and texture, can significantly aect print quality.
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the
card stock loaded in the tray.
Print samples on the card stock being considered for use before buying large quantities.
Specify the paper texture and weight from the tray settings to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Preprinting, perforation, and creasing may significantly aect the print quality and cause jams or other paper
feed problems.
Before loading the card stock on the tray, flex and fan the card stock to loosen them. Straighten the edges
on a level surface.
Tips on using envelopes
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the
envelopes loaded in the tray.
Print samples on the envelopes being considered for use before buying large quantities.
Use envelopes designed specifically for laser printers.
For best performance, use envelopes made from 90g/m
2
(24lb) paper or 25% cotton.
Use only new envelopes from undamaged packages.
To optimize performance and minimize jams, do not use envelopes that:
Have excessive curl or twist.
Are stuck together or damaged in any way.
Have windows, holes, perforations, cutouts, or embossing.
Have metal clasps, string ties, or folding bars.
Have an interlocking design.
Have postage stamps attached.
Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position.
Paper and specialty media guide 178
background
Have bent corners.
Have rough, cockle, or laid finishes.
Adjust the width guides to fit the width of the envelopes.
Before loading the envelopes on the tray, flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and
then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Note: A combination of high humidity (over 60%) and high printing temperature may wrinkle or seal
envelopes.
Tips on using labels
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the
labels loaded in the tray.
Print samples on labels being considered for use before buying large quantities.
For more information on label printing, characteristics, and design, see the Card Stock & Label Guide on
the Lexmark Web site at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Use labels designed specifically for laser printers.
Do not use labels with slick backing material.
Do not use labels with exposed adhesive.
Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels to peel o during printing, resulting in a jam. Partial
sheets also contaminate the printer and the cartridge with adhesive, and could void the printer and toner
cartridge warranties.
Before loading labels on the tray, flex and fan labels to loosen them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Note: Vinyl and polyester labels are supported only in the MS710 Series printer models.
Tips on using transparencies
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the
transparencies loaded in the tray.
Print a test page on the transparencies being considered for use before buying large quantities.
Use transparencies designed specifically for laser printers.
Avoid getting fingerprints on the transparencies to prevent print quality problems.
Before loading transparencies, flex and fan the sheets to prevent them from sticking together.
When printing on large volumes of transparencies, make sure to print by batches of only up to 20 with an
interval of at least three minutes between batches, to prevent the transparencies from sticking together in
the bin. You can also remove transparencies from the bin by batches of 20.
Paper and specialty media guide 179
background
Paper guidelines
Selecting the correct paper or specialty media reduces printing problems. For the best print quality, try a sample
of the paper or specialty media before buying large quantities.
Paper characteristics
The following paper characteristics aect print quality and reliability. Consider these factors before printing on
them:
Weight
The printer trays and multipurpose feeder can automatically feed paper weights between 60–176 g/m
2
(16–
47lb) grain long paper. The 2100sheet tray can automatically feed paper weights up to 60–135 g/m
2
(16–36lb)
grain long paper. Paper lighter than 60 g/m
2
(16 lb) might not be sti enough to feed properly, and may cause
jams.
Note: Twosided printing is supported for 60–176 g/m
2
(16–47lb) paper.
Curl
Curl is the tendency for paper to curl at its edges. Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems. Curl can
occur after the paper passes through the printer, where it is exposed to high temperatures. Storing paper
unwrapped in hot, humid, cold, or dry conditions, even in the trays, can contribute to paper curling prior to
printing and can cause feeding problems.
Smoothness
Paper smoothness directly aects print quality. If paper is too rough, toner cannot fuse to it properly. If paper
is too smooth, it can cause paper feeding or print quality issues. Always use paper between 100 and 300
Sheeld points; smoothness between 150 and 250 Sheeld points produces the best print quality.
Moisture content
The amount of moisture in paper aects both print quality and the ability of the printer to feed the paper correctly.
Leave paper in its original wrapper until it is time to use it. This limits the exposure of paper to moisture changes
that can degrade its performance.
Store paper in its original wrapper in the same environment as the printer for 24 to 48 hours before printing.
Extend the time several days if the storage or transportation environment is very dierent from the printer
environment. Thick paper may also require a longer conditioning period.
Grain direction
Grain refers to the alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of paper. Grain is either grain long, running the length
of the paper, or grain short, running the width of the paper.
For 60–176 g/m
2
(16–47lb) paper, grain long paper is recommended.
Fiber content
Most highquality xerographic paper is made from 100% chemically treated pulped wood. This content provides
the paper with a high degree of stability, resulting in fewer paper feeding problems and better print quality.
Paper containing fibers such as cotton can negatively aect paper handling.
Paper and specialty media guide 180
background
Selecting paper
Using the appropriate paper prevents jams and helps ensure troublefree printing.
To help avoid paper jams and poor print quality:
Always use new, undamaged paper.
Before loading paper, know the recommended printable side of the paper. This information is usually
indicated on the paper package.
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.
Do not mix paper sizes, types, or weights in the same tray; mixing results in jams.
Do not use coated papers unless they are specifically designed for electrophotographic printing.
Selecting preprinted forms and letterhead
Use grain long for 60–90g/m
2
(16–24lb) paper.
Use only forms and letterhead printed using an oset lithographic or engraved printing process.
Avoid paper with rough or heavily textured surfaces.
Use inks that are not aected by the resin in toner. Inks that are oxidationset or oilbased generally meet
these requirements; latex inks might not.
Print samples on preprinted forms and letterheads considered for use before buying large quantities. This
determines whether or not the ink in the preprinted form or letterhead will aect print quality.
When in doubt, contact your paper supplier.
Using recycled paper and other
oce
papers
As an environmentally conscientious company, Lexmark supports the use of recycled paper produced
specifically for use in laser (electrophotographic) printers.
While no blanket statement can be made that all recycled paper will feed well, Lexmark consistently tests papers
that represent recycled cut size copier papers available on the global market. This scientific testing is conducted
with rigor and discipline. Many factors are taken into consideration both separately and as a whole, including
the following:
Amount of post-consumer waste (Lexmark tests up to 100% post-consumer waste content.)
Temperature and humidity conditions (Testing chambers simulate climates from all over the world.)
Moisture content (Business papers should have low moisture: 4–5%.)
Bending resistance and proper stiness means optimum feeding through the printer.
Thickness (impacts how much can be loaded into a tray)
Surface roughness (measured in Sheeld units, impacts print clarity and how well toner fuses to the paper)
Surface friction (determines how easily sheets can be separated)
Grain and formation (impacts curling, which also
influences
the mechanics of how the paper behaves as it
moves through the printer)
Brightness and texture (look and feel)
Recycled papers are better than ever; however, the amount of recycled content in a paper
aects
the degree
of control over foreign matter. And while recycled papers are one good path to printing in an environmentally
responsible manner, they are not perfect. The energy required to de-ink and deal with additives such as
colorants and “glue” often generates more carbon emissions than does normal paper production. However,
using recycled papers enables better resource management overall.
Paper and specialty media guide 181
background
Lexmark concerns itself with the responsible use of paper in general based on life cycle assessments of its
products. To gain a better understanding of the impact of printers on the environment, the company
commissioned a number of life cycle assessments and found that paper was identified as the primary contributor
(up to 80%) of carbon emissions caused throughout the entire life of a device (from design to end-of-life). This
is due to the energy-intensive manufacturing processes required to make paper.
Thus, Lexmark seeks to educate customers and partners on minimizing the impact of paper. Using recycled
paper is one way. Eliminating excessive and unnecessary paper consumption is another. Lexmark is well-
equipped to help customers minimize printing and copying waste. In addition, the company encourages
purchasing paper from suppliers who demonstrate their commitment to sustainable forestry practices.
Lexmark does not endorse specific suppliers, although a converter’s product list for special applications is
maintained. However, the following paper choice guidelines will help alleviate the environmental impact of
printing:
1 Minimize paper consumption.
2 Be selective about the origin of wood
fiber.
Buy from suppliers who carry
certifications
such as the Forestry
Stewardship Council (FSC) or The Program for the Endorsement of Forest Certification (PEFC). These
certifications guarantee that the paper manufacturer uses wood pulp from forestry operators that employ
environmentally and socially responsible forest management and restoration practices.
3 Choose the most appropriate paper for printing needs: normal 75 or 80 g/m
2
certified paper, lower weight
paper, or recycled paper.
Unacceptable paper examples
Test results indicate that the following paper types are at risk for use with laser printers:
Chemically treated papers used to make copies without carbon paper, also known as carbonless papers
Preprinted papers with chemicals that may contaminate the printer
Preprinted papers that can be aected by the temperature in the printer fuser
Preprinted papers that require a registration (the precise location on the page) greater than ± 2.3 mm (± 0.9
in.), such as optical character recognition (OCR) forms. In some cases, registration can be adjusted with a
software application to successfully print on these forms.)
Coated papers (erasable bond), synthetic papers, thermal papers
Rough-edged, rough or heavily textured surface papers or curled papers
Recycled papers that fail EN12281:2002 (European testing)
Paper weighing less than 60 g/m
2
(16 lb)
Multiple part forms or documents
For more information about Lexmark, visit
www.lexmark.com. General sustainability-related information can
be found at the Environmental Sustainability link.
Storing paper
Use these paper storage guidelines to help avoid jams and uneven print quality:
For best results, store paper where the temperature is 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40 percent.
Most label manufacturers recommend printing in a temperature range of 18–24°C (65–75°F) with relative
humidity between 40 and 60 percent.
Store paper in cartons, on a pallet or shelf, rather than on the floor.
Store individual packages on a
flat
surface.
Paper and specialty media guide 182
background
Do not store anything on top of individual paper packages.
Take paper out of the carton or wrapper only when you are ready to load it in the printer. The carton and
wrapper help keep the paper clean, dry, and
flat.
Supported paper sizes, types, and weights
The following tables provide information on standard and optional paper sources and the sizes, types, and
weights of paper they support.
Paper types and weights supported by the printer
The printer engine supports 60–176g/m
2
(16–47lb) paper weights.
Paper type 250 or 550sheet
trays
2100sheet tray Multipurpose feeder Duplex
Paper
Card stock X
Plain Envelope X X
Rough Envelope
X X
Paper labels
X X
Pharmacy labels
X
Transparencies* X X
* Print on transparencies by batches of only up to 20 to prevent them from sticking together. For more information,
see
“Tips on using transparencies” on page 179.
Paper sizes supported by the printer
Note: When printing on paper less than 210 mm (8.3 inches) wide, the printer may print at a reduced speed
after a period of time to ensure the best print performance.
Paper and specialty media guide 183
background
Paper size
1
Dimensions Standard or
optional 250
or 550sheet
tray
Optional
2100sheet tray
Multipurpose
feeder
Duplex
A4 210 x 297 mm (8.3
x 11.7 in.)
A5 148 x 210 mm (5.8 x
8.3 in.)
2
A6 105 x 148 mm (4.1 x
5.8 in.)
X
JIS B5 182 x 257 mm (7.2 x
10.1 in.)
X
Letter 216 x 279 mm (8.5
x 11 in.)
Legal 216 x 356 mm (8.5
x 14 in.)
Executive 184 x 267 mm (7.3 x
10.5 in.)
X
Oficio 216 x 340 mm (8.5
x 13.4 in.)
Folio 216 x 330 mm (8.5
x 13 in.)
Statement 140 x 216 mm (5.5 x
8.5 in.)
X
Universal
3
105 x 148 mm to
216 x 356 mm (4.13
x 5.83 in. to 8.5 x 14
in.)
X
70 x 127 mm to 216
x 356 mm (2.76 x 5
to 8.5 x 14 in.)
XX X
7 3/4 Envelope
(Monarch)
98 x 191 mm (3.9 x
7.5 in.)
X X
9 Envelope 98 x 225 mm (3.9 x
8.9 in.)
X X
10 Envelope 105 x 241 mm (4.1 x
9.5 in.)
X X
1
If your preferred default paper size cannot be set in the printer control panel, then you may select common paper
sizes that correspond to the position of the length guide in the tray from the Paper Size/Type menu. If the paper
size is not available, then select Universal or turn o tray size sensing. For more information, contact customer
support.
2
Paper is supported in longedge orientation.
3
Universal is supported in duplex mode only if the width is from 105 mm (4.13 in.) to 216 mm (8.5 in.), and the length
is from 148 mm (5.83 in.) to 356 mm (14 in.).
Paper and specialty media guide 184
background
Paper size
1
Dimensions Standard or
optional 250
or 550sheet
tray
Optional
2100sheet tray
Multipurpose
feeder
Duplex
DL Envelope 110 x 220 mm (4.3 x
8.7 in.)
X X
C5 Envelope 162 x 229 mm (6.38
x 9.01 in.)
X X
B5 Envelope 176 x 250 mm (6.93
x 9.84 in.)
X X
Other Envelope 98 x 162 mm (3.9 x
6.4 in.) to 176 x 250
mm (6.9 x 9.8 in.)
X X
1
If your preferred default paper size cannot be set in the printer control panel, then you may select common paper
sizes that correspond to the position of the length guide in the tray from the Paper Size/Type menu. If the paper
size is not available, then select Universal or turn o tray size sensing. For more information, contact customer
support.
2
Paper is supported in longedge orientation.
3
Universal is supported in duplex mode only if the width is from 105 mm (4.13 in.) to 216 mm (8.5 in.), and the length
is from 148 mm (5.83 in.) to 356 mm (14 in.).
Paper sizes, types, and weights supported by the output options
Supported paper sizes
Paper size 4bin mailbox Output expander
and highcapacity
output expander
Staple finisher Staple, hole punch
finisher
A6
XX
A5
1 1,3
JIS B5
2 2
Executive
2 2
Letter
A4
Legal
3
Folio
1
The finisher staples the paper if it is loaded long edge first.
2
The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.
3
The finisher stacks and staples the paper but does not punch holes in it.
4
The finisher staples the paper if its width is from 210 mm (8.27 in.) to 217 mm (8.54 in.).
Paper and specialty media guide 185
background
Paper size 4bin mailbox Output expander
and highcapacity
output expander
Staple finisher Staple, hole punch
finisher
Oficio
Statement
2 2
Universal
4 3,4
Envelopes
X
XX
1
The finisher staples the paper if it is loaded long edge first.
2
The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.
3
The
finisher
stacks and staples the paper but does not punch holes in it.
4
The
finisher
staples the paper if its width is from 210 mm (8.27 in.) to 217 mm (8.54 in.).
Supported paper types and weights
Paper type Paper weight 4bin mailbox Output
expander and
highcapacity
output expander
Staple finisher Staple, hole
punch finisher
Plain Paper
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Card Stock
163 g/m
2
(90 Ib index)
X
1
1
199 g/m
2
(110 Ib index)
X
XX
Transparency
2
146 g/m
2
(39 Ib bond)
X
1
1
Recycled
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Paper labels
180 g/m
2
(48 Ib bond)
X
XX
Dual web and
Integrated
180 g/m
2
(48 Ib bond)
X
XX
1
The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.
2
Print on transparencies by batches of only up to 20 to prevent them from sticking together. For more information,
see
“Tips on using transparencies” on page 179.
Paper and specialty media guide 186
background
Paper type Paper weight 4bin mailbox Output
expander and
highcapacity
output expander
Staple finisher Staple, hole
punch finisher
Bond
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Envelope
105 g/m
2
(28 Ib bond)
X
XX
Rough Envelope
105 g/m
2
(28 Ib bond)
X
XX
Letterhead
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Preprinted
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Colored Paper
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Light paper
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Heavy paper
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
Rough/cotton
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
1
The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.
2
Print on transparencies by batches of only up to 20 to prevent them from sticking together. For more information,
see
“Tips on using transparencies” on page 179.
Paper and specialty media guide 187
background
Paper type Paper weight 4bin mailbox Output
expander and
highcapacity
output expander
Staple finisher Staple, hole
punch finisher
Custom type [x]
90–176 g/m
2
(24–47 lb bond)
X
XX
60–90 g/m
2
(16–24 lb bond)
1
The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.
2
Print on transparencies by batches of only up to 20 to prevent them from sticking together. For more information,
see
“Tips on using transparencies” on page 179.
Paper and specialty media guide 188
background
Understanding the printer menus
Menus list
Paper Menu Reports Network/Ports
Default Source
Paper Size/Type
Configure MP
Substitute Size
Paper Texture
Paper Weight
Paper Loading
Custom Types
Custom Names
3
Custom Bin Names
3
Universal Setup
Bin Setup
Menu Settings Page
Device Statistics
Stapler Test
Network Setup Page
1
Profiles
List
Print Fonts
Print Directory
Asset Report
Active NIC
Standard Network
2
Standard USB
Parallel [x]
Serial [x]
SMTP Setup
Security Settings Help
Option Card Menu
5
Edit Security Setups
4
Miscellaneous Security
Settings
3
Confidential Print
Erase Temporary Data Files
Security Audit Log
Set Date and Time
General Settings
Flash Drive Menu
Print Settings
Print All Guides
Print Quality
Printing Guide
Print Defects Guide
Information Guide
Supplies Guide
A list of installed DLEs
(Download Emulators)
appears.
1
Depending on the printer setup, this menu item appears as Network Setup Page or Network [x] Setup Page.
2
Depending on the printer setup, this menu item appears as Standard Network or Network [x].
3
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
4
This menu appears only in some touchscreen printer models.
5
This menu appears only when one or more DLEs are installed.
Understanding the printer menus 189
background
Paper menu
Vinyl label is supported only in MS710 Series printer models.
Default Source menu
Use To
Default Source
Tray [x]
Multipurpose Feeder
1
MP Feeder
2
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Set a default paper source for all print jobs.
Notes:
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to "Cassette" for
Multipurpose Feeder or MP Feeder to appear as a menu setting.
If two trays contain paper of the same size and type, and the trays
have the same settings, then the trays are automatically linked.
When one tray is empty, the print job continues using the linked tray.
1
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
2
This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer models.
Paper Size/Type menu
Use To
Tray [x] Size
A4
A5
A6
JISB5
Letter
Legal
Executive
Oficio
(Mexico)
Folio
Statement
Universal
7 3/4 Envelope
9 Envelope
10 Envelope
DL Envelope
C5 Envelope
B5 Envelope
Other Envelope
Specify the paper size loaded in each tray.
Notes:
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international
factory default setting.
If two trays contain paper of the same size and type, and the trays
have the same settings, then the trays are automatically linked. The
multipurpose feeder may also be linked. When one tray is empty,
the print job continues using the linked tray.
The A6 paper size is supported only in Tray 1 and in the
multipurpose feeder.
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.
Understanding the printer menus 190
background
Use To
Tray [x] Type
Plain Paper
Card Stock
Transparency
Recycled
Labels
Bond
Envelope
Rough Envelope
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Light Paper
Heavy Paper
Rough/Cotton
Custom Type [x]
Specify the paper type loaded in each tray.
Notes:
Plain Paper is the factory default setting for Tray 1. Custom Type [x]
is the factory default setting for all other trays.
If available, a userdefined name will appear instead of Custom
Type [x].
Use this menu to configure automatic tray linking.
MP Feeder Size
A4
A5
A6
JIS B5
Letter
Legal
Executive
Oficio (Mexico)
Folio
Statement
Universal
7 3/4 Envelope
9 Envelope
10 Envelope
DL Envelope
C5 Envelope
B5 Envelope
Other Envelope
Specify the paper size loaded in the multipurpose feeder.
Notes:
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international
factory default setting.
From the Paper menu, set
Configure
MP to “Cassette” for MP
Feeder Size to appear as a menu.
The multipurpose feeder does not automatically detect paper size.
Make sure to set the paper size value.
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.
Understanding the printer menus 191
background
Use To
MP Feeder Type
Plain Paper
Card Stock
Transparency
Recycled
Labels
Bond
Envelope
Rough Envelope
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Light Paper
Heavy Paper
Rough/Cotton
Custom Type [x]
Specify the paper type loaded in the multipurpose feeder.
Notes:
Plain Paper is the factory default setting.
From the Paper menu, set Configure to “Cassette” for MP Feeder
Type to appear as a menu.
Manual Paper Size
A4
A5
A6
JIS B5
Letter
Legal
Executive
Oficio (Mexico)
Folio
Statement
Universal
Specify the paper size being manually loaded.
Note: Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international
factory default setting.
Manual Paper Type
Plain Paper
Card Stock
Transparency
Recycled
Labels
Bond
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Light Paper
Heavy Paper
Rough/Cotton
Custom Type [x]
Specify the paper type being manually loaded.
Notes:
Plain Paper is the factory default setting.
From the Paper menu, set
Configure
MP to “Manual” for Manual
Paper Type to appear as a menu.
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.
Understanding the printer menus 192
background
Use To
Manual Envelope Size
7 3/4 Envelope
9 Envelope
10 Envelope
DL Envelope
C5 Envelope
B5 Envelope
Other Envelope
Specify the envelope size being manually loaded.
Note: 10 Envelope is the U.S. factory default setting. DL Envelope is the
international factory default setting.
Manual Envelope Type
Envelope
Rough Envelope
Custom Type [x]
Specify the envelope type being manually loaded.
Note: Envelope is the factory default setting.
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.
Configure MP menu
Use To
Configure MP
Cassette
Manual
First
Determine when the printer selects paper from the multipurpose feeder.
Notes:
Cassette is the factory default setting. Cassette configures the
multipurpose feeder as the automatic paper source.
Manual sets the multipurpose feeder only for manualfeed print jobs.
First configures the multipurpose feeder as the primary paper
source.
Substitute Size menu
Use To
Substitute Size
O
Statement/A5
Letter/A4
All Listed
Substitute a specified paper size if the requested paper size is not
available.
Notes:
All Listed is the factory default setting. All available substitutions are
allowed.
O indicates that no size substitutions are allowed.
Setting a size substitution lets the print job continue without Change
Paper appearing.
Understanding the printer menus 193
background
Paper Texture menu
Use To
Plain Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the plain paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Card Stock Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the card stock loaded in a specific tray.
Notes:
Normal is the factory default setting.
These options appear only if card stock is supported.
Transparency Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the transparencies loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Recycled Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the recycled paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Labels Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the labels loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Vinyl Labels Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the vinyl labels loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Bond Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the bond paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.
Envelope Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the envelopes loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Rough Envelope Texture
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the rough envelopes loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.
Letterhead Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the letterhead loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 194
background
Use To
Preprinted Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the preprinted paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Colored Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the colored paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Light Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the light paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Heavy Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the heavy paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Rough/Cotton Texture
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the rough or cotton paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.
Custom [x] Texture
Smooth
Normal
Rough
Specify the relative texture of the custom paper loaded in a specific tray.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Paper Weight menu
Use To
Plain Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the plain paper loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Card Stock Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the card stock loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Transparency Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the transparencies loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Recycled Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the recycled paper loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 195
background
Use To
Labels Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the labels loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Vinyl Labels Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the vinyl labels loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Bond Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the bond paper loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Envelope Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the envelope loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Rough Envelope Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the rough envelope loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Letterhead Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the letterhead loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Preprinted Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the preprinted paper loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Colored Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the colored paper loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Light Weight
Light
Specify that the weight of the paper loaded is light.
Heavy Weight
Heavy
Specify that the weight of the paper loaded is heavy.
Rough/Cotton Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the cotton or rough paper loaded.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 196
background
Use To
Custom [x] Weight
Light
Normal
Heavy
Specify the relative weight of the custom paper loaded.
Notes:
Normal is the factory default setting.
The options appear only when the custom type is supported.
Paper Loading menu
Use To
Card Stock Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Card
Stock as the paper type.
Recycled Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with
Recycled as the paper type.
Labels Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Labels
as the paper type.
Vinyl Labels Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Vinyl
Labels as the paper type.
Bond Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Bond
as the paper type.
Letterhead Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with
Letterhead as the paper type.
Preprinted Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with
Preprinted as the paper type.
Colored Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with
Colored as the paper type.
Light Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Light
as the paper type.
Notes:
O
is the factory default setting for all Paper Loading menu selections.
Duplex sets the printer default to twosided printing for every print job unless onesided printing is selected
from Print Properties or the print dialog, depending on your operating system.
Understanding the printer menus 197
background
Use To
Heavy Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Heavy
as the paper type.
Rough/Cotton Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Rough
or Cotton as the paper type.
Custom [x] Loading
Duplex
O
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with
Custom [x] as the paper type.
Note: Custom [x] Loading is available only when the custom
type is supported.
Notes:
O
is the factory default setting for all Paper Loading menu selections.
Duplex sets the printer default to twosided printing for every print job unless onesided printing is selected
from Print Properties or the print dialog, depending on your operating system.
Custom Types menu
Use To
Custom Type [x]
Paper
Card Stock
Transparency
Rough/Cotton
Labels
Vinyl Labels
Envelope
Associate a paper or specialty media type with a factory default custom
type name or a userdefined custom name created from the Embedded
Web Server or from MarkVision
TM
Professional.
Notes:
Paper is the factory default setting.
The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or
multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source.
Recycled
Paper
Card Stock
Transparency
Rough/Cotton
Labels
Vinyl Labels
Envelope
Specify a paper type when Recycled is selected in other menus.
Notes:
Paper is the factory default setting.
The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or
multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source.
Custom Names menu
Use To
Custom Name [x] Specify a custom name for a paper type. This name replaces the Custom
Type [x] name in the printer menus.
Note: This menu item appears only in touchscreen printer models.
Understanding the printer menus 198
background
Custom Bin Names menu
Note: This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
Use To
Standard Bin Specify a custom name for the standard bin.
Bin [x] Specify a custom name for Bin [x].
Universal Setup menu
Use To
Units of Measure
Inches
Millimeters
Identify the units of measure.
Notes:
Inches is the U.S. factory default setting.
Millimeters is the international factory default setting.
Portrait Width
3–14.17 inches
76–360 mm
Set the portrait width.
Notes:
If the width exceeds the maximum, then the printer uses the
maximum width allowed.
8.5 inches is the U.S. factory default setting. You can increase
the width in 0.01inch increments.
216 mm is the international factory default setting. You can
increase the width in 1mm increments.
Portrait Height
3–14.17 inches
76–360 mm
Set the portrait height.
Notes:
If the height exceeds the maximum, then the printer uses the
maximum height allowed.
14 inches is the U.S. factory default setting. You can increase the
height in 0.01inch increments.
356 mm is the international factory default setting. You can
increase the height in 1mm increments.
Feed Direction
Short Edge
Long Edge
Specify the feed direction if the paper can be loaded in either
direction.
Notes:
Short Edge is the factory default setting.
Long Edge appears only when the longest edge is shorter than
the maximum width supported in the tray.
Understanding the printer menus 199
background
Bin Setup menu
Use To
Output Bin
Standard Bin
Bin [x]
Specify the default bin.
Notes:
If multiple bins are assigned the same name, then
the name appears only once in the menu.
Standard Bin is the factory default setting.
Configure Bins
Mailbox
Link
Mail Overflow
Link Optional
Type Assignment
Specify configuration options for bins.
Notes:
Mailbox is the factory default setting. This setting
treats each bin as a separate mailbox.
Link
configures
all available bins as one large bin.
Mail Overflow configures each bin as a separate
mailbox.
Link Optional links all available bins except the
standard bin and only appears when at least two
optional bins are installed.
Type Assignment assigns each paper type to a
bin or linked bin set.
Bins assigned the same name are automatically
linked unless Link Optional is selected.
Overflow Bin
Standard Bin
Bin [x]
Specify an alternative bin when a designated bin is full.
Notes:
Standard Bin is the factory default setting.
If multiple bins are assigned the same name, then
the name only appears once in the bin list.
[x] can be any number between 1 and 12 if the
appropriate optional bins are installed.
Understanding the printer menus 200
background
Use To
Assign Type/Bin
Plain Paper Bin
Card Stock Bin
Transparency Bin
Recycled Bin
Labels Bin
Vinyl Labels Bin
Bond Bin
Envelope Bin
Rough Envelope Bin
Letterhead Bin
Preprinted Bin
Colored Bin
Light Paper Bin
Heavy Paper Bin
Rough/Cotton Bin
Custom [x] Bin
Select a bin for each supported paper type.
For each type, select the following options:
Disabled
Standard Bin
Bin [x]
Notes:
Disabled is the factory default setting.
[x] can be any number between 1 and 12 if the
appropriate optional bins are installed.
If multiple bins are assigned the same name, then
the name only appears once in the bin list.
Reports menu
Reports menu
Use To
Menu Settings Page Print a report containing information about the paper loaded in trays,
installed memory, total page count, alarms, timeouts, printer control panel
language, TCP/IP address, status of supplies, status of the network
connection, and other information.
Device Statistics Print a report containing printer statistics such as supply information and
details about printed pages.
Stapler Test Print a report that confirms that the staple finisher is functioning properly.
Note: This menu appears only if an optional staple
finisher
is installed.
Network Setup Page Print a report containing information about the network printer settings, such
as the TCP/IP address information.
Note: This menu item appears only in network printers or in printers
connected to print servers.
Network [x] Setup Page Print a report containing information about the network printer settings, such
as the TCP/IP address information.
Notes:
This menu item is available only when more than one network option
is installed.
This menu item appears only in network printers or in printers
connected to print servers.
Understanding the printer menus 201
background
Use To
Profiles List Print a list of profiles stored in the printer.
Note: This menu item appears only when LDSS is enabled.
Print Fonts
PCL Fonts
PostScript Fonts
Print a report of all the fonts available for the printer language currently set
in the printer.
Note: A separate list is available for PCL and PostScript emulations.
Print Directory Print a list of all the resources stored in an optional flash memory card or
printer hard disk.
Notes:
Job Buer Size must be set to 100%.
Make sure the optional flash memory or printer hard disk is installed
correctly and working properly.
This menu item appears only when an optional flash drive or printer
hard disk is installed.
Asset Report Print a report containing printer asset information, such as serial number
and model name.
Network/Ports menu
Active NIC menu
Use To
Active NIC
Auto
[list of available network cards]
Allow the printer to connect to a network.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
This menu item appears only if an optional network adapter is installed.
Standard Network or Network [x] menu
Note: Only active ports appear in this menu.
Use To
Energy Ecient Ethernet
Enable
Disable
Reduce power consumption when the printer receives no data from the
Ethernet network.
Note: Enable is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 202
background
Use To
PCL SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job
requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
If PCL SmartSwitch is disabled, then the printer does not examine
incoming data and it uses the default printer language specified in the
Setup menu.
PS SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job requires
it, regardless of the default printer language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
If PS SmartSwitch is disabled, then the printer does not examine
incoming data and it uses the default printer language specified in the
Setup menu.
NPA Mode
O
Auto
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
The printer automatically restarts when the setting is changed from the
control panel.
Network Buer
Auto
3KB to [maximum size allowed]
Set the size of the network input buer.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the
printer, the size of the other link buers, and whether Resource Save is
set to On or O.
To increase the maximum size range for the Network Buer, disable or
reduce the size of the parallel, serial, and USB buers.
The printer automatically restarts when the setting is changed from the
control panel.
Job Buering
O
On
Auto
Temporarily store print jobs in the printer hard disk before printing. This menu
only appears when a formatted disk is installed.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
The printer automatically restarts when the setting is changed from the
control panel. The menu selection is then updated.
Mac Binary PS
On
O
Auto
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 203
background
Use To
Standard Network Setup OR
Network [x] Setup
Reports
Network Card
TCP/IP
IPv6
Wireless
AppleTalk
Show and set the printer network settings.
Note: The Wireless menu appears only when the printer is connected to a
wireless network.
Reports menu
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > Reports
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Reports
Use To
Print Setup Page Print a report containing information about the network printer settings, such as the TCP/IP
address.
Network Card menu
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > Network Card
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Network Card
Use To
View Card Status
Connected
Disconnected
View the connection status of the wireless network adapter.
View Card Speed View the speed of an active wireless network adapter.
Network Address
UAA
LAA
View the network addresses.
Job Timeout
0, 10–225 seconds
Set the amount of time it takes for a network print job to be canceled.
Notes:
“90 seconds” is the factory default setting.
A setting value of 0 disables the timeout.
If a value between 1 and 9 is selected, then Invalid appears on the
display, and the value is not saved.
Banner Page
O
On
Allow the printer to print a banner page.
Note: O is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 204
background
TCP/IP menu
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > TCP/IP
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > TCP/IP
Note: This menu is available only in network printers or printers attached to print servers.
Use To
Set Hostname Set the current TCP/IP host name.
Note: This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.
IP Address View or change the current TCP/IP address.
Note: Manually setting the IP address sets the Enable DHCP and Enable Auto
IP settings to
O.
It also sets Enable BOOTP and Enable RARP to
O
on
systems that support BOOTP and RARP.
Netmask View or change the current TCP/IP netmask.
Gateway View or change the current TCP/IP gateway.
Enable DHCP
On
O
Specify the DHCP address and parameter assignment.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Enable RARP
On
O
Specify the RARP address assignment setting.
Note:
O
is the factory default setting.
Enable BOOTP
On
O
Specify the BOOTP address assignment setting.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Enable AutoIP
Ye s
No
Specify the Zero Configuration Networking setting.
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.
Enable FTP/TFTP
Ye s
No
Enable the built-in FTP server, which lets you send files to the printer using File
Transfer Protocol.
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.
Enable HTTP Server
Ye s
No
Enable the built-in Web server (Embedded Web Server). When enabled, the
printer can be monitored and managed remotely using a Web browser.
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.
WINS Server Address View or change the current WINS server address.
Enable DDNS
Ye s
No
View or change the current DDNS setting.
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.
Enable mDNS
Ye s
No
View or change the current mDNS setting.
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.
DNS Server Address View or change the current DNS server address.
Understanding the printer menus 205
background
Use To
Backup DNS Server Address View or change the backup DNS server addresses.
Backup DNS Server Address 2
Backup DNS Server Address 3
Enable HTTPS
Ye s
No
View or change the current HTTPS setting.
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.
IPv6 menu
To access the menu, navigate to any of the following:
Network/Ports menu > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > IPv6
Network/Ports menu > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > IPv6
Note: This menu is available only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Use To
Enable IPv6
On
O
Enable IPv6 in the printer.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Auto Configuration
On
O
Specify whether or not the network adapter accepts the automatic
IPv6 address configuration entries provided by a router.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Set Hostname Set the host name.
Note: These settings can be changed only from the Embedded
Web Server.
View Address
View Router Address
Enable DHCPv6
On
O
Enable DHCPv6 in the printer.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Wireless menu
Note: This menu is available only in printers connected to a wireless network or printer models that have a
wireless network adapter.
To access the menu, navigate to:
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless
Understanding the printer menus 206
background
Use To
WiFi Protected Setup
Start Push Button Method
Start PIN Method
Establish a wireless network and enable network security.
Notes:
Start Push Button Method connects the printer to a wireless
network when buttons on both the printer and the access point
(wireless router) are pressed within a given period of time.
Start PIN Method connects the printer to a wireless network
when a PIN on the printer is entered into the wireless settings
of the access point.
Enable/Disable WPS Autodetection
Enable
Disable
Automatically detect the connection method that an access point
with WPS uses—Start Push Button Method or Start PIN Method.
Note: Disable is the factory default setting.
Network Mode
BSS Type
Infrastructure
Ad hoc
Specify the network mode.
Notes:
Infrastructure is the factory default setting. This lets the printer
access a network using an access point.
Ad hoc
configures
wireless connection directly between the
printer and a computer.
Compatibility
802.11b/g
802.11b/g/n
Specify the wireless standard for the wireless network.
Note: 802.11b/g/n is the factory default setting.
Choose Network Select an available network for the printer to use.
View Signal Quality View the quality of the wireless connection.
View Security Mode View the encryption method for the wireless network.
AppleTalk menu
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > AppleTalk
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > AppleTalk
Use To
Activate
Ye s
No
Enable or disable AppleTalk support.
Note: No is the factory default setting.
View Name Show the assigned AppleTalk name.
Note: The AppleTalk name can be changed only from the Embedded
Web Server.
View Address Show the assigned AppleTalk address.
Note: The AppleTalk address can be changed only from the Embedded
Web Server.
Understanding the printer menus 207
background
Use To
Set Zone
[list of zones available on the
network]
Provide a list of AppleTalk zones available on the network.
Note: The default zone for the network is the factory default setting.
Standard USB menu
Use To
PCL SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job
received through a USB port requires it, regardless of the default printer
language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
When set to O, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer
uses PostScript emulation if the PS SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the
default printer language specified in the Setup menu if the PS
SmartSwitch is set to O.
PS SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received
through a USB port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
When set to
O,
the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer
uses PCL emulation if the PCL SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the
default printer language
specified
in the Setup menu if the PCL
SmartSwitch is set to
O.
NPA Mode
On
O
Auto
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting. Auto sets the printer to examine data,
determine the format, and then process it appropriately.
The printer automatically restarts when changing the setting from the
printer control panel. The menu selection is then updated.
Understanding the printer menus 208
background
Use To
USB Buer
Disabled
Auto
3K to [maximum size allowed]
Set the size of the USB input buer.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
Disabled turns o job buering. Any jobs already buered on the printer
hard disk are printed before normal processing resumes.
The USB buer size value can be changed in 1-K increments.
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the
printer, the size of the other link buers, and whether Resource Save is
set to On or O.
To increase the maximum size range for the USB Buer, disable or
reduce the size of the parallel, serial, and network buers.
The printer automatically restarts when the setting is changed from the
printer control panel. The menu selection is then updated.
Job Buering
O
On
Auto
Temporarily store print jobs in the printer hard disk before printing.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
On buers jobs on the printer hard disk.
Auto buers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data from
another input port.
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.
Mac Binary PS
On
O
Auto
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.
O filters print jobs using the standard protocol.
ENA Address
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy
Set the network address information for an external print server.
Note: This menu is available only when the printer is attached to an external
print server through the USB port.
ENA Netmask
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy
Set the netmask information for an external print server.
Note: This menu is available only when the printer is attached to an external
print server through the USB port.
ENA Gateway
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy
Set the gateway information for an external print server.
Note: This menu is available only when the printer is attached to an external
print server through the USB port.
Parallel [x] menu
Note: This menu appears only when an optional parallel card is installed.
Understanding the printer menus 209
background
Use To
PCL SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job
received through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer
language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
When set to O, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer
uses PostScript emulation if PS SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the
default printer language specified in the Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is
set to O.
PS SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
When set to
O,
the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer
uses PCL emulation if PCL SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default
printer language
specified
in the Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to
O.
NPA Mode
On
O
Auto
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.
Parallel Buer
Disabled
Auto
3K to [maximum size allowed]
Set the size of the parallel input buer.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
Disabled turns o job buering. Any print jobs already buered on the
printer hard disk are printed before normal processing resumes.
The parallel buer size setting can be changed in 1KB increments.
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the
printer, the size of the other link buers, and whether Resource Save is
set to On or O.
To increase the maximum size range for the Parallel Buer, disable or
reduce the size of the USB, serial, and network buers.
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.
Understanding the printer menus 210
background
Use To
Job Buering
O
On
Auto
Temporarily store print jobs on the printer hard disk before printing.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
On buers print jobs on the printer hard disk.
Auto buers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data from
another input port.
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.
Advanced Status
On
O
Enable bidirectional communication through the parallel port.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
O disables parallel port negotiation.
Protocol
Standard
Fastbytes
Specify the parallel port protocol.
Notes:
Fastbytes is the factory default setting. It provides compatibility with most
existing parallel ports and is the recommended setting.
Standard tries to resolve parallel port communication problems.
Honor Init
On
O
Determine if the printer honors printer hardware initialization requests from the
computer.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
The computer requests initialization by activating the Init signal from the
parallel port. Many personal computers activate the Init signal each time
the computer is turned on.
Parallel Mode 2
On
O
Determine if the parallel port data is sampled on the leading or trailing edge of
a strobe.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Mac Binary PS
On
O
Auto
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
O filters print jobs using the standard protocol.
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.
ENA Address
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy
Set the network address information for an external print server.
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external
print server through the USB port.
ENA Netmask
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy
Set the netmask information for an external print server.
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external
print server through the USB port.
Understanding the printer menus 211
background
Use To
ENA Gateway
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy
Set the gateway information for an external print server.
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external
print server through the USB port.
Serial [x] menu
Note: This menu appears only when an optional serial card is installed.
Use To
PCL SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job
received through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer
language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
When set to O, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer
uses PostScript emulation if PS SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the
default printer language specified in the Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is
set to O.
PS SmartSwitch
On
O
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
When set to O, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer
uses PCL emulation if PCL SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default
printer language specified in the Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to
O.
NPA Mode
On
O
Auto
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting. Auto sets the printer to examine data,
determine the format, and then processes it appropriately.
When set to On, the printer performs NPA processing. If the data is not in
NPA format, it is rejected as bad data.
When set to O, the printer does not perform NPA processing.
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.
Understanding the printer menus 212
background
Use To
Serial Buer
Disabled
Auto
3K to [maximum size allowed]
Set the size of the serial input buer.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
Disabled turns o job buering. Any jobs already buered on the disk are
printed before normal processing is resumed.
The serial buer size setting can be changed in 1KB increments.
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the
printer, the size of the other link buers, and whether Resource Save is
set to On or O.
To increase the maximum size range for the Serial Buer, disable or
reduce the size of the parallel, serial, and network buers.
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.
Job Buering
O
On
Auto
Temporarily store print jobs on the printer hard disk before printing.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting. The printer does not buer print jobs on
the printer hard disk.
On buers print jobs on the printer hard disk.
Auto buers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data from
another input port.
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.
Protocol
DTR
DTR/DSR
XON/XOFF
XON/XOFF/DTR
XONXOFF/DTRDSR
Select the hardware and software handshaking settings for the serial port.
Notes:
DTR is the factory default setting.
DTR/DSR is a hardware handshaking setting.
XON/XOFF is a software handshaking setting.
XON/XOFF/DTR and XON/XOFF/DTR/DSR are combined hardware and
software handshaking settings.
Robust XON
On
O
Determine whether the printer communicates availability to the computer.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
This menu item applies only to the serial port if Serial Protocol is set to
XON/XOFF.
Understanding the printer menus 213
background
Use To
Baud
1200
2400
4800
9600
19200
38400
57600
115200
138200
172800
230400
345600
Specify the rate at which data can be received through the serial port.
Notes:
9600 is the factory default setting.
138200, 172800, 230400, and 345600 baud rates are only displayed in
the Standard Serial menu. These settings do not appear in the Serial
Option 1, Serial Option 2, or Serial Option 3 menus.
Data Bits
7
8
Specify the number of data bits sent in each transmission frame.
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.
Parity
Even
Odd
None
Ignore
Set the parity for serial input and output data frames.
Note: None is the factory default setting.
Honor DSR
On
O
Determine whether the printer uses the DSR Signal.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
DSR is a handshaking signal used by most serial cables. The serial port
uses DSR to distinguish data sent by the computer from data created by
electrical noise in the serial cable. The electrical noise can cause stray
characters to print. Set this to On to prevent stray characters from
printing.
SMTP Setup menu
Use To
Primary SMTP Gateway Specify SMTP server gateway and port information.
Note: 25 is the default SMTP gateway port.
Primary SMTP Gateway Port
Secondary SMTP Gateway
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port
SMTP Timeout
5–30
Specify the amount of time in seconds before the server stops trying
to send an email.
Note: 30 is the factory default setting.
Reply Address Specify a reply address of up to 128 characters in the e-mail sent by
the printer.
Understanding the printer menus 214
background
Use To
Use SSL
Disabled
Negotiate
Required
Set the printer to use SSL for increased security when connecting to
the SMTP server.
Notes:
Disabled is the factory default setting.
When the Negotiate setting is used, the SMTP server
determines if SSL will be used.
SMTP Server Authentication
No authentication required
Login/Plain
CRAMMD5
DigestMD5
NTLM
Kerberos 5
Specify the type of user authentication required for printing
privileges.
Note: “No authentication required” is the factory default setting.
DeviceInitiated Email
None
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Specify what credentials will be used when communicating to the
SMTP server. Some SMTP servers require credentials to send an e-
mail.
Notes:
None is the factory default setting for DeviceInitiated Email
and UserInitiated Email.
Device Userid and Device Password are used to log in to the
SMTP server when Use Device SMTP Credentials is selected.
UserInitiated Email, Kerberos 5 Realm, and NTLM Domain
appear only in touchscreen printer models.
UserInitiated Email
None
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Use Session User ID & Password
Use Session Email address & Password
Prompt User
Device Userid
Device Password
Kerberos 5 Realm
NTLM Domain
Security menu
Edit Security Setups menu
Note: This menu appears only in select touchscreen printer models.
Use To
Edit Backup Password
Use Backup Password
O
On
Password
Create a backup password.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting for “Use Backup Password.
This menu appears only if a backup password exists.
Understanding the printer menus 215
background
Use To
Edit Building Blocks
Internal Accounts
NTLM
Simple Kerberos Setup
Kerberos Setup
Active Directory
LDAP
LDAP+GSSAPI
Password
PIN
Edit settings for Internal Accounts, NTLM, Simple Kerberos Setup, Kerberos
Setup, Active Directory, LDAP, Password, and PIN.
Edit Security Templates
[list of available templates]
Add or edit a security template.
Edit Access Controls
Administrative Menus
Function Access
Management
Solutions
Cancel jobs at the Device
Control access to printer menus, firmware updates, held jobs, and other access
points.
Miscellaneous Security Settings menu
Note: This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
Use To
Login Restrictions
Login failures
Failure time frame
Lockout time
Panel Login Timeout
Remote Login Timeout
Limit the number and time frames of failed login attempts from the printer
control panel before all users are locked out.
Notes:
“Login failures
specifies
the number of failed login attempts before users
are locked out. Settings range from 1 to 10. 3 attempts is the factory
default setting.
“Failure time frame”
specifies
the time frame during which failed login
attempts can be made before users are locked out. Settings range from 1
to 60 minutes. 5 minutes is the factory default setting.
“Lockout time”
specifies
how long users are locked out after exceeding
the login failures limit. Settings range from 1 to 60 minutes. 5 minutes is
the factory default setting.
Panel Login Timeout specifies how long the printer remains idle on the
printer control panel before automatically logging the user o. Settings
range from 1 to 900 seconds. 30 seconds is the factory default setting.
Remote Login Timeout specifies how long a remote interface remains
idle before automatically logging the user o. Settings range from 1 to
120 seconds. 10 minutes is the factory default setting.
Minimum PIN Length
1–16
Limit the digit length of the PIN.
Note: 4 is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 216
background
Confidential Print menu
Use To
Max Invalid PIN
O
2–10
Limit the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered.
Notes:
This menu appears only when a formatted, non-defective printer hard disk is
installed.
Once the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name and PIN are deleted.
Confidential Job Expiration
O
1 hour
4 hours
24 hours
1 week
Limit the amount of time a confidential print job stays in the printer before it is deleted.
Notes:
If the “Confidential Job Expiration” setting is changed while confidential print
jobs reside in the printer RAM or printer hard disk, then the expiration time for
those print jobs does not change to the new default value.
If the printer is turned o, then all confidential jobs held in the printer RAM are
deleted.
Repeat Job Expiration
O
1 hour
4 hours
24 hours
1 week
Set a time limit on how long the printer stores print jobs.
Verify Job Expiration
O
1 hour
4 hours
24 hours
1 week
Set a time limit on how long the printer stores print jobs needing verification.
Reserve Job Expiration
O
1 hour
4 hours
24 hours
1 week
Set a time limit on how long the printer stores print jobs for printing at a later time.
Note: O is the factory default setting.
Erase Temporary Data Files menu
Erase Temporary Data Files deletes only print job data on the printer hard disk that are not currently in use by
the file system. All permanent data on the printer hard disk are preserved, such as downloaded fonts, macros,
and held jobs.
Note: This menu appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is installed.
Understanding the printer menus 217
background
Use To
Wiping Mode
Auto
Specify the mode for erasing temporary data files.
Automatic Method
Single pass
Multiple pass
Mark all disk space used by a previous print job. This method does not permit
the file system to reuse this space until it has been cleared.
Notes:
“Single pass” is the factory default setting.
Only automatic wiping enables users to erase temporary data
files
without having to turn o the printer for an extended amount of time.
Highly
confidential
information should be erased using only the Multiple
pass method.
Security Audit Log menu
Use To
Export Log Let an authorized user export the audit log.
Notes:
To export the audit log from the printer control panel, a flash drive must
be attached to the printer.
The audit log can be downloaded from the Embedded Web Server and
saved on a computer.
Delete Log
Ye s
No
Specify whether or not audit logs are deleted.
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.
Configure Log
Enable Audit
Ye s
No
Enable Remote Syslog
No
Ye s
Remote Syslog Facility
0–23
Severity of events to log
0–7
Specify how and whether or not audit logs are created.
Notes:
Enable Audit determines if events are recorded in the secure audit log
and remote syslog. No is the factory default setting.
Enable Remote Syslog determines if logs are sent to a remote server. No
is the factory default setting.
Remote Syslog Facility determines the value used to send logs to the
remote syslog server. 4 is the factory default setting.
If the security audit log is activated, then the severity value of each event
is recorded. 4 is the factory default setting.
Set Date and Time menu
Use To
Current Date and Time Show the current date and time settings for the printer.
Understanding the printer menus 218
background
Use To
Manually Set Date and Time
[input date/time]
Enter the date and time.
Notes:
Manually setting the date and time sets Enable NTP to No.
The wizard lets you set the date and time in YYYYMMDDHH:MM
format.
Time Zone
[list of time zones]
Select the time zone.
Note: GMT is the factory default setting.
Automatically observe DST
On
O
Set the printer to use the applicable daylight saving time (DST) start and end
times associated with the printer Time Zone setting.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Enable NTP
On
O
Enable Network Time Protocol, which synchronizes the clocks of devices on a
network.
Notes:
On is the factory default setting.
The setting is turned o if you manually set the date and time.
Understanding the printer menus 219
background
Settings menu
General Settings menu
Use To
Display Language
English
Francais
Deutsch
Italiano
Espanol
Dansk
Norsk
Nederlands
Svenska
Portuguese
Suomi
Russian
Polski
Greek
Magyar
Turkce
Cesky
Simplified Chinese
Traditional Chinese
Korean
Japanese
Set the language of the text that appears on the display.
Note: Not all languages are available for all printer models.
You may need to install special hardware for some
languages.
Show Supply Estimates
Show estimates
Do not show estimates
View supply estimates on the control panel, Embedded Web
Server, menu settings, and device statistics reports.
Note: Show estimates is the factory default setting.
Eco-Mode
O
Energy
Energy/Paper
Paper
Minimize the use of energy, paper, or specialty media.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
Setting Eco-Mode to Energy or Paper may aect printer
performance, but not print quality.
Quiet Mode
O
On
Reduce printer noise.
Note:
O
is the factory default setting.
Run Initial Setup
Ye s
No
Run the setup wizard.
Understanding the printer menus 220
background
Use To
Keyboard
Keyboard Type
English
Francais
Francais Canadien
Deutsch
Italiano
Espanol
Greek
Dansk
Norsk
Nederlands
Svenska
Suomi
Portuguese
Russian
Polski
Swiss German
Swiss French
Korean
Magyar
Turkish
Czech
Simplified Chinese
Traditional Chinese
Japanese
Custom Key 1
Custom Key 2
Specify a language and custom key information for the
keyboard on the display.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
Custom Key 2 appears only in some touchscreen printer
models.
Paper Sizes
US
Metric
Specify the unit of measurement for paper sizes.
Note: US is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 221
background
Use To
Displayed Information
Left side
Right side
Specify the display information in the upper corners of the
home screen.
Select from the following options:
None
IP Address
Hostname
Contact Name
Location
Date/Time
mDNS/DDNS Service Name
Zero Configuration Name
Custom Text [x]
Model Name
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
IP Address is the factory default setting for Left side.
Date/Time is the factory default setting for Right side.
Displayed Information (continued)
Custom Text [x]
Customize the text to display in the upper corners of the home
screen.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
You can type up to 32 characters.
Displayed Information (continued)
Black Toner
Specify the display information for Black Toner.
Select from the following options:
When to display
Do not display
Display
Message to Display
Default
Alternate
Default
[text entry]
Alternate
[text entry]
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
Do not display is the factory default setting for When to
display.
Default is the factory default setting for Message to
Display.
Understanding the printer menus 222
background
Use To
Displayed Information (continued)
Paper Jam
Load Paper
Service Errors
Specify the display information for Paper Jam, Load Paper, and
Service Errors.
Select from the following options:
Display
Ye s
No
Message to Display
Default
Alternate
Default
[text entry]
Alternate
[text entry]
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
No is the factory default setting for Display.
Default is the factory default setting for Message to
Display.
Home screen customization
Change language
Search Held Jobs
Held Jobs
USB Drive
Profiles and Apps
Bookmarks
Jobs by user
Change the icons that appear on the control panel.
Select from the following options:
Display
Do not display
Notes:
Profiles
and Apps appears only in touchscreen printer
models.
Display is the factory default setting for Search Held
Jobs, Held jobs, and USB Drive.
Do not display is the factory default setting for Change
Language,
Profiles
and Apps, Bookmarks, and Jobs by
user.
Home screen customization
Forms and Favorites
Background and Idle Screen
Eco-Settings
Change the icons that appear on the control panel.
Select from the following options:
Display
Do not display
Notes:
These settings appear only in touchscreen printer
models.
Display is the factory default setting.
Date Format
MMDDYYYY
DDMMYYYY
YYYYMMDD
Format the printer date.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
MM-DD-YYYY is the U.S. factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 223
background
Use To
Time Format
12 hour A.M./P.M.
24 hour clock
Format the printer time.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
12 hour A.M./P.M. is the factory default setting.
Screen Brightness
20–100
Specify the brightness of the display.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
100 is the factory default setting.
Output Lighting
Normal/Standby Mode
O
Dim
Bright
Set the amount of light from the bin.
Notes:
If Eco-Mode is set to Energy or Energy/Paper, then Dim is
the factory default setting.
If Eco-Mode is set to
O
or Paper, then Bright is the
factory default setting.
This menu appears only when an indicator light is
installed in the bin or an optional bin with an indicator
light is added.
Audio Feedback
Button Feedback
On
O
Volume
1–10
Set the button volume and feedback.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
On is the factory default setting for Button Feedback.
5 is the factory default setting for Volume.
Show Bookmarks
Ye s
No
Specify whether to display bookmarks from the Held Jobs
area.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
Yes is the factory default setting.
Web Page Refresh Rate
30–300
Specify the time between Embedded Web Server refreshes.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
120 seconds is the factory default setting.
Contact Name Specify a contact name for the printer.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
The contact name is stored on the Embedded Web
Server.
Understanding the printer menus 224
background
Use To
Location Specify the printer location.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
The location is stored on the Embedded Web Server.
Alarms
Alarm Control
Cartridge Alarm
Staple Alarm
Hole Punch Alarm
Set an alarm when the printer requires user intervention.
Select from the following options:
O
Single
Continuous
Notes:
Single is the factory default setting for Alarm Control.
O is the factory default setting for Cartridge Alarm,
Staple Alarm, and Hole Punch Alarm.
Timeouts
Standby Mode
Disabled
1–240
Set the idle time before the printer enters a lower power state.
Notes:
Standby Mode appears only in touchscreen printer
models.
15 minutes is the factory default setting.
Timeouts
Sleep Mode
Disabled
1–120
Set the idle time before the printer begins operating in Sleep
Mode.
Notes:
20 minutes is the factory default setting.
Disabled appears only when Energy Conserve is set to
O.
Timeouts
Print with Display O
Allow printing with display
o
Display on when printing
Print a job with the display turned o.
Note: Display on when printing is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 225
background
Use To
Timeouts
Hibernate Timeout
Disabled
20 minutes
1 hour
2 hours
3 hours
6 hours
1 day
2 days
3 days
1 week
2 weeks
1 month
Set the time before the printer enters Hibernate mode.
Note: 3 days is the factory default setting.
Timeouts
Hibernate Timeout on Connection
Hibernate
Do Not Hibernate
Set the printer to Hibernate mode even if there is an active
Ethernet or fax connection.
Note: Do Not Hibernate is the factory default setting.
Timeouts
Screen Timeout
15–300
Set the idle time before the display automatically returns to
Ready state.
Note: 30 seconds is the factory default setting.
Timeouts
Prolong Screen Timeout
O
On
Remain in the same location and reset the Screen Timeout
timer instead of returning to the home screen.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
O
is the factory default setting.
Timeouts
Print Timeout
Disabled
1–255
Set the printer to end a print job after it has been idle for the
specified amount of time.
Notes:
90 seconds is the factory default setting.
When the timer expires, any partially printed page still in
the printer is printed.
Print Timeout is available only when using PCL
emulation.
Timeouts
Wait Timeout
Disabled
15–65535
Set the time the printer waits to receive for more data before
canceling a print job.
Notes:
40 seconds is the factory default setting.
Wait Timeout is available only when the printer is using
PostScript emulation.
Understanding the printer menus 226
background
Use To
Timeouts
Job Hold Timeout
5–255
Set the time the printer waits for user intervention before it
holds jobs that require unavailable resources.
Notes:
30 seconds is the factory default setting.
This menu appears only when a hard disk is installed.
Error Recovery
Auto Reboot
Reboot when idle
Reboot always
Reboot never
Set the printer to restart when an error occurs.
Note: Reboot always is the factory default setting.
Error Recovery
Max Auto Reboots
1–20
Determine the number of automatic reboots the printer can
perform.
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.
Print Recovery
Auto Continue
Disabled
5–255
Let the printer automatically continue printing from certain
oine situations when these are not resolved within the
specified time period.
Note: Disabled is the factory default setting.
Print Recovery
Jam Recovery
On
O
Auto
Specify whether the printer reprints jammed pages.
Note: Auto is the factory default setting. The printer reprints
jammed pages unless other tasks need the memory required
to hold the pages.
Print Recovery
Jam Assist
On
O
Set the printer to check for jammed paper automatically.
Note: On is the factory default setting.
Print Recovery
Page Protect
O
On
Set the printer to print the correct output for a page.
Note:
O
is the factory default setting.
Accessibility Settings
Prolong Screen Timeout
On
O
Remain in the same location and reset the Screen Timeout
timer instead of returning to the home screen.
Notes:
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
O is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 227
background
Use To
Accessibility Settings
Speech Rate
Very Slow
Slow
Normal
Fast
Faster
Very Fast
Rapid
Very Rapid
Fastest
Adjust the Voice Guidance speaking rate.
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.
Accessibility Settings
Headphone Volume
1–10
Set the headphones volume.
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.
Information Sent to Lexmark
Supplies and Page Usage (Anonymous)
On
O
Send anonymous device usage information to Lexmark.
Note: The default value depends on what you selected
during the initial setup.
Press Sleep Button
Do Nothing
Sleep
Hibernate
Determine how the printer, while in idle state, reacts to a short
press of the Sleep button.
Note: Sleep is the factory default setting.
Press and Hold Sleep Button
Do Nothing
Sleep
Hibernate
Determine how the printer, while in idle state, reacts to a long
press of the Sleep button.
Note: Do Nothing is the factory default setting.
Factory Defaults
Do Not Restore
Restore Now
Restore the printer factory default settings.
Notes:
Do Not Restore is the factory default setting.
All downloads stored in the RAM are deleted.
Downloads stored in the flash memory or in the printer
hard disk are not aected.
Custom Home Message
O
IP Address
Hostname
Contact Name
Location
Zero Configuration Name
Custom Text 1
Select a custom home message that appears as an alternating
display of the printer status.
Note: This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer
models.
Export Configuration Package
Export
Export the configuration package to a flash drive.
Understanding the printer menus 228
background
Use To
Export Compressed Logs File
Export
Export the compressed logs file to a flash drive.
Flash Drive Menu
Print Settings menu
Use To
Copies
1–999
Specify a default number of copies for each print job.
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.
Paper Source
Tray [x]
Multipurpose Feeder
1
MP Feeder
2
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Set a default paper source for all print jobs.
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.
Collate
(1,1,1) (2,2,2)
(1,2,3) (1,2,3)
Stack the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies.
Note: “(1,2,3) (1,2,3)” is the factory default setting.
Sides (Duplex)
1 sided
2 sided
Specify whether prints are on one side or on both sides of the page.
Note: 1 sided is the factory default setting.
Staple
O
On
Specify whether prints are stapled.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
On allows the printer to staple print jobs.
This menu appears only when a supported staple finisher is installed.
Hole Punch
O
On
Specify whether prints have holes for binding.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
This menu appears only when a supported staple, hole punch
finisher
is
installed.
Hole Punch Mode
2 holes
3 holes
4 holes
Specify the number of holes to be made on the prints.
Notes:
“3 holes” is the U.S. factory default setting. “4 holes” is the international
factory default setting.
This menu appears only when a supported staple, hole punch
finisher
is
installed.
1
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
2
This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer models.
Understanding the printer menus 229
background
Use To
Duplex Binding
Long Edge
Short Edge
Define the way duplexed pages are bound and printed.
Notes:
Long Edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge
for portrait and top edge for landscape). This is the factory default setting.
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge
for portrait and left edge for landscape).
Paper Saver Orientation
Auto
Landscape
Portrait
Specify the orientation of a multiplepage document.
Notes:
Auto is the factory default setting.
This setting
aects
jobs if the value of the Paper Saver setting in the
same menu is not set to
O.
Paper Saver
O
2Up
3Up
4Up
6Up
9Up
12Up
16Up
Specify that multiplepage images be printed on one side of a paper.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
The number selected is the number of page images that will print per
side.
Paper Saver Border
None
Solid
Print a border on each page image when using NUp (pages per side).
Notes:
None is the factory default setting.
This setting aects jobs if the value of the Paper Saver setting in the
same menu is not set to O.
Paper Saver Ordering
Horizontal
Reverse Horizontal
Reverse Vertical
Vertical
Specify the positioning of multiplepage images when using NUp (pages per
side).
Notes:
Horizontal is the factory default setting.
Positioning depends on the number of page images and whether they
are in portrait or landscape orientation.
This setting aects jobs if the value of the Paper Saver setting in the
same menu is not set to O.
1
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
2
This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer models.
Understanding the printer menus 230
background
Use To
Separator Sheets
O
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Specify if blank separator sheets are inserted.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if
Collate is set to “(1,2,3) (1,2,3).” If Collate is set to “(1,1,1) (2,2,2),” then a
blank page is inserted between each set of printed pages, such as after
all page 1's and after all page 2's.
Between Jobs inserts a blank sheet between print jobs.
Between Pages inserts a blank sheet between each page of the print job.
This setting is useful when printing on transparencies or when inserting
blank pages in a document for notes.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [x]
Manual Feeder
Multipurpose Feeder
1
MP Feeder
2
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.
Blank Pages
Do Not Print
Print
Specify if blank pages are inserted in a print job.
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.
1
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
2
This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer models.
Print Settings
Setup menu
Use To
Printer Language
PCL Emulation
PS Emulation
Set the default printer language.
Notes:
PCL Emulation is the factory default setting.
PostScript emulation uses a PostScript interpreter for
processing print jobs.
PCL Emulation uses a PCL interpreter for processing
print jobs.
Setting a printer language default does not prevent a
software program from sending print jobs that use
another printer language.
Understanding the printer menus 231
background
Use To
Job Waiting
On
O
Specify that print jobs be removed from the print queue when
they require unavailable printer options or custom settings.
They are stored in a separate print queue, so other jobs print
normally. When the missing information or options, or both are
obtained, the stored jobs print.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
This menu appears only when a formatted, working
printer hard disk is installed. This requirement ensures
that stored jobs are not deleted if the printer loses
power.
Print Area
Normal
Fit to Page
Whole Page
Set the logical and physical printable area.
Notes:
Normal is the factory default setting. When attempting to
print data in the nonprintable area
defined
by the
Normal setting, the printer clips the image at the
boundary.
Fit to Page
fits
the page content into the selected paper
size.
Whole Page allows the image to be moved into the
nonprintable area
defined
by the Normal setting, but the
printer clips the image at the Normal setting boundary.
This setting aects only pages printed using a PCL 5e
interpreter and has no eect on pages printed using the
PCL XL or PostScript interpreter.
Download Target
RAM
Flash
Disk
Set the storage location for downloads.
Notes:
RAM is the factory default setting. Storing downloads in
the RAM is temporary.
Storing downloads in a flash memory or in a printer hard
disk places them in permanent storage. Downloads
remain in the flash memory or printer hard disk even
when the printer is turned
o.
This menu item appears only if an optional flash memory
or a formatted, working printer hard disk is installed.
Understanding the printer menus 232
background
Use To
Resource Save
On
O
Specify how the printer handles temporary downloads, such
as fonts and macros stored in the RAM, when the printer
receives a print job that requires more than the available
memory.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting. This sets the printer to
retain downloads only until memory is needed.
Downloads are deleted in order to process print jobs.
On sets the printer to retain downloads during language
changes and printer resets. If the printer runs out of
memory, then Memory Full [38] appears on the
printer display, but downloads are not deleted.
Print All Order
Alphabetical
Oldest First
Newest First
Specify the order in which held and confidential jobs are
printed when Print All is selected.
Note: Alphabetical is the factory default setting.
Finishing menu
Use To
Sides (Duplex)
1 sided
2 sided
Specify whether twosided (duplex) printing is set as the default for all print jobs.
Notes:
“1 sided” is the factory default setting.
You can set twosided printing from the printer software.
For Windows users:
Click File > Print, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or
Setup.
For Macintosh users:
Choose File > Print, and then adjust the settings from the Print dialog and
popup menus.
Duplex Binding
Long Edge
Short Edge
Define the way duplexed pages are bound and printed.
Notes:
Long Edge is the factory default setting. Long Edge assumes binding
along the long edge of the page (left edge for portrait and top edge for
landscape).
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge
for portrait and left edge for landscape).
Copies
1–999
Specify the default number of copies for each print job.
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.
1
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
2
This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer models.
Understanding the printer menus 233
background
Use To
Blank Pages
Do Not Print
Print
Specify whether blank pages are inserted in a print job.
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.
Collate
(1,1,1) (2,2,2)
(1,2,3) (1,2,3)
Stack the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies.
Note: “(1,1,1) (2,2,2)” is the factory default setting.
Separator Sheets
O
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Specify whether blank separator sheets are inserted.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if
Collate is set to “(1,2,3) (1,2,3).” If Collate is set to “(1,1,1) (2,2,2),” then a
blank page is inserted between each set of printed pages, such as after
all page 1's and after all page 2's.
Between Jobs inserts a blank sheet between print jobs.
Between Pages inserts a blank sheet between each page of a print job.
This setting is useful when printing transparencies or when inserting
blank pages in a document.
Separator Source
Tray [x]
Multipurpose Feeder
1
MP Feeder
2
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Notes:
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.
From the Paper menu, set
Configure
MP to "Cassette" for Multipurpose
Feeder or MP Feeder to appear as a menu setting.
Paper Saver
O
2Up
3Up
4Up
6Up
9Up
12Up
16Up
Print multiplepage images on one side of a paper.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
The number selected is the number of page images that will print per
side.
Paper Saver Ordering
Horizontal
Reverse Horizontal
Reverse Vertical
Vertical
Specify the positioning of multiplepage images when using Paper Saver.
Notes:
Horizontal is the factory default setting.
Positioning depends on the number of page images and whether they
are in portrait or landscape orientation.
1
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
2
This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer models.
Understanding the printer menus 234
background
Use To
Paper Saver Orientation
Auto
Landscape
Portrait
Specify the orientation of a multiplepage document.
Note: Auto is the factory default setting. The printer chooses between
portrait and landscape.
Paper Saver Border
None
Solid
Print a border when using Paper Saver.
Note: None is the factory default setting.
Staple Job
O
On
Specify whether printed output is stapled.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
This menu appears only when a supported staple finisher is installed.
Run Stapler Test Print a report that confirms that the staple finisher is functioning properly.
Note: This menu appears only when a supported staple
finisher
is installed.
Hole Punch
On
O
Specify whether holes will be created on printed outputs for the purpose of
collecting the sheets in a binder or folder.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
This menu appears only when a supported staple, hole punch
finisher
is
installed.
Hole Punch Mode
2 holes
3 holes
4 holes
Specify the number of holes to be created on printed outputs for the purpose
of collecting the sheets in a binder or folder.
Notes:
“3 holes” is the U.S. factory default setting. “4 holes” is the international
factory default setting.
This menu appears only when a supported staple, hole punch finisher is
installed.
Oset Pages
None
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Oset pages at certain instances.
Notes:
None is the factory default setting.
Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if
Collate is set to “(1,2,3) (1,2,3).” If Collate is set to “(1,1,1) (2,2,2),” then a
blank page is inserted between each set of printed pages, such as after
all page 1's and after all page 2's.
Between Jobs sets the same oset position for the entire print job
regardless of the number of copies printed.
This menu appears only when a supported staple
finisher
is installed.
1
This menu appears only in touchscreen printer models.
2
This menu appears only in nontouchscreen printer models.
Understanding the printer menus 235
background
Quality menu
Use To
Print Resolution
300 dpi
600 dpi
1200 dpi
1200 Image Q
2400 Image Q
Specify the printed output resolution in dots per inch.
Note: 600 dpi is the factory default setting.
Pixel Boost
O
Fonts
Horizontally
Vertically
Both directions
Enable more pixels to print in clusters for clarity, in order to enhance images
horizontally or vertically, or to enhance fonts.
Note:
O
is the factory default setting.
Toner Darkness
1–10
Lighten or darken the printed output.
Notes:
8 is the factory default setting.
Selecting a smaller number can help conserve toner.
Enhance Fine Lines
On
O
Enable a print mode preferable for files such as architectural drawings, maps,
electrical circuit diagrams, and flow charts.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
To set this option using the Embedded Web Server, type the network printer
IP address in the Web browser address field.
Gray Correction
Auto
O
Automatically adjust the contrast enhancement applied to images.
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.
Brightness
6 to 6
Adjust the printed output either by lightening or darkening it. You can conserve
toner by lightening the output.
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.
Contrast
0–5
Adjust the contrast of printed objects.
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.
Job Accounting menu
Note: This menu item appears only when a printer hard disk is installed. Make sure that the hard disk is not
read/write or writeprotected.
Use To
Job Accounting Log
O
On
Set if the printer creates a log of the print jobs it receives.
Note: O is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 236
background
Use To
Job Accounting Utilities Print and delete log files or export them to a flash drive.
Accounting Log Frequency
Daily
Weekly
Monthly
Set how often a log file is created.
Note: Monthly is the factory default setting.
Log Action at End of Frequency
None
Email Current Log
Email & Delete Current Log
Post Current Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Set how the printer responds when the frequency threshold expires.
Note: None is the factory default setting.
Log Near Full Level
O
1–99
Specify the maximum size of the log file before the printer executes the Log
Action at Near Full.
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.
Log Action at Near Full
None
Email Current Log
Email & Delete Current Log
Email & Delete Oldest Log
Post Current Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Post & Delete Oldest Log
Delete Current Log
Delete Oldest Log
Delete All Logs
Delete All But Current
Set how the printer responds when the hard disk is nearly full.
Notes:
None is the factory default setting.
The value
defined
in Log Near Full Level determines when this action is
triggered.
Log Action at Full
None
Email & Delete Current Log
Email & Delete Oldest Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Post & Delete Oldest Log
Delete Current Log
Delete Oldest Log
Delete All Logs
Delete All But Current
Set how the printer responds when disk usage reaches the maximum limit
(100MB).
Note: None is the factory default setting.
URL to Post Logs Set where the printer posts job accounting logs.
Email to Send Logs Specify the email address to which the device sends job accounting logs.
Log File Prefix Specify the prefix you want for the log file name.
Note: The current host name
defined
in the TCP/IP menu is used as the
default log
file
prefix.
Understanding the printer menus 237
background
Utilities menu
Use To
Remove Held Jobs
Confidential
Held
Not Restored
All
Delete confidential and held jobs from the printer hard disk.
Notes:
Selecting a setting aects only print jobs that are stored in the printer
hard disk. Bookmarks, print jobs on flash drives, and other types of held
jobs are not
aected.
Not Restored removes all Print and Hold jobs that are not restored from
the printer hard disk or printer memory.
Format Flash
Ye s
No
Format the flash memory.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not turn
o
the printer while the
flash
memory is being formatted.
Notes:
Yes deletes all data stored in the flash memory.
No cancels the format request.
Flash memory refers to the memory added by installing a flash memory
card in the printer.
The flash memory option card must not be read/write or writeprotected.
This menu item appears only when a formatted, working flash memory
card is installed.
Delete Downloads on Disk
Delete Now
Do Not Delete
Delete downloads from the printer hard disk, including all held jobs, buered
jobs, and parked jobs.
Notes:
Delete Now sets the printer to delete the downloads and allows the
display to return to the originating screen after the deletion.
Do Not Delete sets the printer display to return to the main Utilities menu.
Activate Hex Trace Assist in isolating the source of a print job problem.
Notes:
When activated, all data sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and
character representation, and control codes are not executed.
To exit or deactivate Hex Trace, turn o the printer.
Coverage Estimator
O
On
Provide an estimate of the percentage coverage of toner on a page. The
estimate is printed on a separate page at the end of each print job.
Note:
O
is the factory default setting.
XPS menu
Use To
Print Error Pages
O
On
Print a page containing information on errors, including XML markup errors.
Note: O is the factory default setting.
Understanding the printer menus 238
background
PDF menu
Use To
Scale to Fit
Ye s
No
Scale page content to fit the selected paper size.
Note: No is the factory default setting.
Annotations
Do Not Print
Print
Print annotations in a PDF.
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.
PostScript menu
Use To
Print PS Error
On
O
Print a page containing the PostScript error.
Note: O is the factory default setting.
Lock PS Startup Mode
On
O
Disable the SysStart file.
Note:
O
is the factory default setting.
Font Priority
Resident
Flash/Disk
Establish the font search order.
Notes:
Resident is the factory default setting.
This menu item is available only when a formatted
flash
memory
option card or printer hard disk is installed and operating properly.
Make sure the flash memory option or printer hard disk is not
read/write, write, or passwordprotected.
Job Buer Size must not be set to 100%.
PCL Emul menu
Use To
Font Source
Resident
Disk
Download
Flash
All
Specify the set of fonts used by the Font Name menu.
Notes:
“Resident” is the factory default setting. Resident shows the factory
default set of fonts downloaded in the RAM.
“Flash” and “Disk” settings show all fonts resident in that option.
The flash option must be properly formatted and cannot be
read/write, write, or passwordprotected.
“Download” shows all the fonts downloaded in the RAM.
All” shows all fonts available to any option.
Understanding the printer menus 239
background
Use To
Font Name
Courier 10
Identify a specific font and the option where it is stored.
Note: Courier 10 is the factory default setting. Courier 10 shows the font
name, font ID, and the storage location in the printer. The font source
abbreviation is R for Resident, F for Flash, K for Disk, and D for
Download.
Symbol Set
10U PC8
12U PC850
Specify the symbol set for each font name.
Notes:
10U PC8 is the US factory default setting. 12U PC850 is the
international factory default setting.
A symbol set is a set of alphabetic and numeric characters,
punctuation, and special symbols. Symbol sets support the dierent
languages or
specific
programs such as math symbols for
scientific
text. Only the supported symbol sets are shown.
PCL Emulation Settings
Point Size
1.00–1008.00
Change the point size for scalable typographic fonts.
Notes:
12 is the factory default setting.
Point size refers to the height of the characters in the font. One point
equals approximately 0.014 inch.
Point sizes can be increased or decreased in 0.25point increments.
PCL Emulation Settings
Pitch
0.08–100
Specify the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts.
Notes:
10 is the factory default setting.
Pitch refers to the number of fixedspace characters per inch (cpi).
Pitch can be increased or decreased in 0.01cpi increments.
For nonscalable monospaced fonts, the pitch appears on the display
but it cannot be changed.
PCL Emulation Settings
Orientation
Portrait
Landscape
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.
Notes:
Portrait is the factory default setting. Portrait prints text and graphics
parallel to the short edge of the page.
Landscape prints text and graphics parallel to the long edge of the
page.
PCL Emulation Settings
Lines per Page
1–255
Specify the number of lines that print on each page.
Notes:
60 is the US factory default setting. 64 is the international default
setting.
The printer sets the amount of space between each line based on
the Lines per Page, Paper Size, and Orientation settings. Select the
Paper Size and Orientation you want before setting Lines per Page.
Understanding the printer menus 240
background
Use To
PCL Emulation Settings
A4 Width
198 mm
203 mm
Set the printer to print on A4size paper.
Notes:
“198 mm” is the factory default setting.
The 203mm setting sets the width of the page to allow printing of
eighty 10pitch characters.
PCL Emulation Settings
Auto CR after LF
On
O
Specify whether the printer automatically performs a carriage return (CR)
after a line feed (LF) control command.
Note: O is the factory default setting.
PCL Emulation Settings
Auto LF after CR
On
O
Specify whether the printer automatically performs a line feed (LF) after a
carriage return (CR) control command.
Note:
O
is the factory default setting.
Tray Renumber
Assign MP Feeder
O
None
0–199
Assign Tray [x]
O
None
0–199
Assign Manual Paper
O
None
0–199
Assign Manual Env
O
None
0–199
Configure the printer to work with printer software or programs that use
dierent source assignments for trays and feeders.
Notes:
“O” is the factory default setting.
“None” ignores the Select Paper Feed command. This option
appears only when it is selected by the PCL 5 interpreter.
“0–199” allows a custom setting to be assigned.
Tray Renumber
View Factory Defaults
MPF Default = 8
T1 Default = 1
T1 Default = 4
T1 Default = 5
T1 Default = 20
T1 Default = 21
Env Default = 6
MPaper Default = 2
MEnv Default = 3
Display the factory default setting assigned to each tray or feeder.
Understanding the printer menus 241
background
Use To
Tray Renumber
Restore Defaults
Ye s
No
Restore all tray and feeder assignments to the factory default settings.
PPDS menu
Menu item Description
Orientation
Portrait
Landscape
Sets the orientation of the text and graphics on the page
Notes:
Portrait is the factory default setting.
Settings are duplicated in the PCL Emulation menu.
Lines per Page
1–255
Sets the number of lines that print on each page
Notes:
64 is the factory default setting.
The printer sets the amount of space between each line based on
the Lines per Page, Paper Size, and Orientation settings. Select the
desired Paper Size and Orientation before setting Lines per Page.
Lines per Inch
0.2530.00
Sets the number of lines that print per inch
Notes:
6 is the factory default setting.
Lines per Inch can be increased or decreased in 0.25inch
increments
Page Format
Print
Whole
Sets the logical and physical printable area of the page
Notes:
Print is the factory default setting. Print data maintains its position
with respect to edge of the paper.
When Whole is selected, document margins are calculated from the
top left corner of the physical edge of the page.
Printing does not occur outside the printable area.
Character Set
1
2
Specifies a default character set for PPDS print jobs
Notes:
2 is the factory default setting. Character Set 2 is composed of
printable characters and symbols used in nonUS English languages.
When Characters Set 1 is selected, values given to the printer are
interpreted as printer commands.
Best Fit
On
O
Replaces a missing font with a similar font
Note: On is the factory default setting. If the requested font is not found,
the printer will use a similar font.
Understanding the printer menus 242
background
Menu item Description
Tray 1 Renumber
O
Tray 2
Configures the printer to work with printer software or programs that use
dierent source assignments for trays, drawers, and feeders
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
Tray 2 is displayed only when it is installed.
Auto CR after LF
On
O
Specifies whether the printer automatically performs a carriage return (CR)
after a line feed (LF) control command
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
Settings are duplicated in the PCL Emulation menu.
Auto LF after CR
On
O
Specifies whether the printer automatically performs a line feed (LF) after
a carriage return (CR) control command
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
Settings are duplicated in the PCL Emulation menu.
Understanding the printer menus 243
background
HTML menu
Use To
Font Name
Albertus MT
Antique Olive
Apple Chancery
Arial MT
Avant Garde
Bodoni
Bookman
Chicago
Clarendon
Cooper Black
Copperplate
Coronet
Courier
Eurostile
Garamond
Geneva
Gill Sans
Goudy
Helvetica
Hoefler Text
Intl CG Times
Intl Courier
Intl Univers
Joanna MT
Letter Gothic
Lubalin Graph
Marigold
MonaLisa Recut
Monaco
New CenturySbk
New York
Optima
Oxford
Palatino
StempelGaramond
Tay
Times
TimesNewRoman
Univers
Zapf Chancery
NewSansMTJA
NewSansMTCS
NewSansMTCT
NewSansMTKO
Set the default font for HTML documents.
Note: The Times font is used in HTML documents that do
not specify a font.
Use To
Font Size
1–255 pt
Set the default font size for HTML documents.
Notes:
12 pt is the factory default setting.
Font size can be increased in 1point increments.
Scale
1–400%
Scale the default font for HTML documents.
Notes:
100% is the factory default setting.
Scaling can be increased in 1% increments.
Orientation
Portrait
Landscape
Set the page orientation for HTML documents.
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.
Margin Size
8–255 mm
Set the page margin for HTML documents.
Notes:
19 mm is the factory default setting.
Margin size can be increased in 1mm increments.
Understanding the printer menus 244
background
Use To
Backgrounds
Do Not Print
Print
Specify whether to print backgrounds on HTML documents.
Note: Print is the factory default setting.
Image menu
Use To
Auto Fit
On
O
Select the optimal paper size, scaling, and orientation.
Note: On is the factory default setting. It overrides scaling and orientation
settings for some images.
Invert
On
O
Invert bitonal monochrome images.
Notes:
O is the factory default setting.
This setting does not apply to GIF or JPEG images.
Scaling
Anchor Top Left
Best Fit
Anchor Center
Fit Height/Width
Fit Height
Fit Width
Scale the image to fit the selected paper size.
Notes:
Best Fit is the factory default setting.
When Auto Fit is set to On, Scaling is automatically set to Best Fit.
Orientation
Portrait
Landscape
Reverse Portrait
Reverse Landscape
Set the image orientation.
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.
Help menu
Menu item Description
Print All Guides Prints all the guides
Print Quality Provides information about solving print quality issues
Printing Guide Provides information about loading paper and other specialty media
Media Guide Provides a list of the paper sizes supported in trays and feeders
Print Defects Guide Provides a template for determining the cause of repeating print quality
defects, and lists settings that can be used to adjust print quality
Menu Map Provides a list of the control panel menus and settings
Information Guide Provides help in locating additional information
Connection Guide Provides information about connecting the printer locally (USB) or to a
network
Understanding the printer menus 245
background
Menu item Description
Moving Guide Provides instructions for safely moving the printer
Supplies Guide Provides information about ordering supplies
Understanding the printer menus 246
background
Saving money and the environment
Lexmark is committed to environmental sustainability and is continually improving its printers to reduce their
impact on the environment. We design with the environment in mind, engineer our packaging to reduce
materials, and provide collection and recycling programs. For more information, see:
The Notices chapter
The Environmental Sustainability section of the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com/environment
The Lexmark recycling program at www.lexmark.com/recycle
By selecting certain printer settings or tasks, you may be able to reduce your printer's impact even further. This
chapter outlines the settings and tasks that may yield a greater environmental benefit.
Adjusting the brightness of the printer display
To save energy, or if you have trouble reading the display, adjust its brightness settings.
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears
as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > General Settings.
3 In the Screen Brightness field, enter the brightness percentage you want for the display.
4 Click Submit.
Saving paper and toner
Studies show that as much as 80% of the carbon footprint of a printer is related to paper usage. You can
significantly
reduce your carbon footprint by using recycled paper and the following printing suggestions, such
as printing on both sides of the paper and printing multiple pages on one side of a single sheet of paper.
For information on how you can quickly save paper and energy using one printer setting, see the following:
“Using EcoMode” on page 75 for nontouchscreen printer models
“Using EcoMode” on page 123 and “Using EcoMode” on page 171 for touchscreen printer models
Using recycled paper
As an environmentally conscious company, Lexmark supports the use of recycled oce paper produced
specifically for use in laser printers. For more information on recycled papers that work well with your printer,
see
“Using recycled paper and other
oce
papers” on page 181.
Saving money and the environment 247
background
Conserving supplies
Print on both sides of the paper.
Note: Two-sided printing is the default setting in the print driver.
Print multiple pages on a single sheet of paper.
Use the preview feature to see how the document looks like before printing it.
Print one copy of the document to check its content and format for accuracy.
Recycling
Lexmark provides collection programs and environmentally progressive approaches to recycling. For more
information, see:
The Notices chapter
The Environmental Sustainability section of the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com/environment
The Lexmark recycling program at www.lexmark.com/recycle
Recycling Lexmark products
To return Lexmark products for recycling:
1 Go to www.lexmark.com/recycle.
2 Select the product you want to recycle.
Note: Printer supplies and hardware not listed in the Lexmark Collection and Recycling Program may be
recycled through your local recycling center.
Recycling Lexmark packaging
Lexmark continually strives to minimize packaging. Less packaging helps to ensure that Lexmark printers are
transported in the most ecient and environmentally sensitive manner and that there is less packaging to
dispose of. These
eciencies
result in fewer greenhouse emissions, energy savings, and natural resource
savings.
Lexmark cartons are 100% recyclable where corrugated recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist in your
area.
The foam used in Lexmark packaging is recyclable where foam recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist
in your area.
When you return a cartridge to Lexmark, you can reuse the box that the cartridge came in. Lexmark will recycle
the box.
Returning Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling
The Lexmark Cartridge Collection Program allows you to return used cartridges for free to Lexmark for reuse
or recycling. One hundred percent of the empty cartridges returned to Lexmark are either reused or
demanufactured for recycling. The boxes used to return the cartridges are also recycled.
Saving money and the environment 248
background
To return Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling, do the following:
1 Go to www.lexmark.com/recycle.
2 Select the product that you want to recycle.
Saving money and the environment 249
background
Maintaining the printer
Ordering supplies
To order parts and supplies in the U.S., contact Lexmark at 1-800-539-6275 for information about Lexmark
authorized supplies dealers in your area. In other countries or regions, go to
www.lexmark.com or contact the
place where you purchased the printer.
Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-party
supplies or parts may aect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging components. Use
of third-party supplies or parts can aect warranty coverage. Damage caused by the use of third-party supplies
or parts is not covered by the warranty. All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and
parts, and may deliver unpredictable results if third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage
beyond the intended life may damage your Lexmark printer or its associated components.
Estimated number of remaining pages
The estimated number of remaining pages is based on the recent printing history of the printer. Its accuracy
may vary significantly and is dependent on many factors, such as actual document content, print quality settings,
and other printer settings.
The accuracy of the estimated number of remaining pages may decrease when the actual printing consumption
is
dierent
from the historical printing consumption. Consider the variable level of accuracy before purchasing
or replacing supplies based on the estimate. Until an adequate print history is obtained on the printer, the
estimated cartridge yield is based on approximately 5% coverage per page.
Ordering toner cartridges
Notes:
Estimated cartridge yield is based on the ISO/IEC 19752 standard.
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may negatively aect actual yield.
Maintaining the printer 250
background
MS810, MS811, and MS812 Return program cartridges
Item United States
and Canada
European
Economic
Area (EEA+)
Rest of
Europe,
Middle East,
and Africa
(RoEMEA)
Latin America
Distribution
(LAD)
Rest of Asia
Pacific (RoAP)
Australia and
New Zealand
(ANZ)
Tone r
cartridge
52D1000 52D2000 52D5000 52D4000 52D3000 52D3000
High yield
toner cartridge
52D1H00 52D2H00 52D5H00 52D4H00 52D3H00 52D3H00
Extra high
yield toner
cartridge*
52D1X00 52D2X00 52D5X00 52D4X00 52D3X00 52D3X00
* This supply item is supported only in MS811 and MS812 printer models.
For more information on countries located in each region, go to
www.lexmark.com/regions.
MS810, MS811, and MS812 Regular cartridges
Item Regular cartridge
Worldwide
High yield toner cartridge
52D0HA0
1
Extra high yield toner cartridge
52D0XA0
2
1
This supply item is supported only in MS810 printer model.
2
This supply item is supported only in MS811 and MS812 printer models.
For more information on countries located in each region, go to
www.lexmark.com/regions.
MS817 and MS818 Return program cartridges
Item United
States and
Canada
European
Economic
Area (EEA+)
Rest of Europe,
Middle East,
and Africa
(RoEMEA)
Latin America
Distribution
(LAD)
Rest of Asia
Pacific (RoAP)
Australia and
New Zealand
(ANZ)
Tone r
cartridge
53B1000 53B2000 53B5000 53B4000 53B3000 53B6000
High yield
toner cartridge
53B1H00 53B2H00 53B5H00 53B4H00 53B3H00 53B6H00
Extra high yield
toner
cartridge*
53B1X00 53B2X00 53B5X00 53B4X00 53B3X00 53B6X00
* This supply item is supported only in MS818 printer model.
For more information on countries located in each region, go to
www.lexmark.com/regions.
Maintaining the printer 251
background
MS817 and MS818 Regular cartridges
Item Regular cartridge
Worldwide
High yield toner cartridge
53B0HA0
1
Extra high yield toner cartridge
53B0XA0
2
1
This supply item is supported only in MS817 printer model.
2
This supply item is supported only in MS818 printer model.
For more information on countries located in each region, go to
www.lexmark.com/regions.
Ordering an imaging unit
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may cause imaging unit parts to fail prior to
exhaustion of toner.
For more information on replacing the imaging unit, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply.
Part name Lexmark Return Program Regular
Imaging unit 520Z 520ZA
Ordering staple cartridges
Item Part number
Staple cartridges 25A0013
Ordering a roller kit
For more information on replacing the roller kit, see the instruction sheet that came with the part.
Lexmark roller kit and part number
Type Part number
Printer engine roller maintenance kit 40X7706
Ordering a maintenance kit
To identify the supported fuser type, view the label on the fuser. Do either of the following:
Remove the toner cartridge and the imaging unit. The two-digit fuser type code (such as 00 or 01) can be
seen on the front of the fuser.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
Pull down the printer rear door. The two-digit fuser type code (such as 00 or 01) can be seen on the rear of
the fuser.
Maintaining the printer 252
background
Notes:
Using certain types of paper may require more frequent replacement of the maintenance kit.
The separator roller, fuser, pick roller assembly, and transfer roller are all included in the maintenance kit
and can be individually ordered and replaced if necessary.
For more information on replacing the maintenance kit, see the instruction sheet that came with the
supply.
Lexmark Return Program fuser maintenance kits and part numbers
Fuser maintenance kit type Part number
Type 00 40X8420
Type 01 40X8421
Type 02 40X8422
Type 03 40X8423
Type 04 40X8424
Lexmark regular fuser maintenance kits and part numbers
Fuser maintenance kit type Part number
Type 05 40X8425
Type 06 40X8426
Type 07 40X8427
Type 08 40X8428
Type 09 40X8429
Storing supplies
Choose a cool, clean storage area for the printer supplies. Store supplies right side up in their original packing
until you are ready to use them.
Do not expose supplies to:
Direct sunlight
Temperatures above 35°C (95°F)
High humidity above 80%
Salty air
Corrosive gases
Heavy dust
Maintaining the printer 253
background
Replacing supplies
Replacing the toner cartridge
1 Lift the front cover, and then pull down the multipurpose feeder door.
2
1
2 Pull the cartridge out of the printer using the handle.
Maintaining the printer 254
background
3 Unpack the new toner cartridge, then remove the packing material, and then shake the cartridge to
redistribute the toner.
4 Insert the toner cartridge into the printer by aligning the side rails of the cartridge with the arrows on the
side rails inside the printer.
Note: Make sure the cartridge is fully pushed in.
Warning—Potential Damage: When replacing a toner cartridge, do not leave the imaging unit exposed to
direct light for an extended period of time. Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
5 Close the multipurpose feeder door and the front cover.
2
1
Maintaining the printer 255
background
Replacing the imaging unit
1 Lift the front cover, and then pull down the multipurpose feeder door.
2
1
2 Pull out the toner cartridge from the printer using the handle.
3 Lift the green handle, and then pull out the imaging unit from the printer.
1
2
Maintaining the printer 256
background
4 Unpack the new imaging unit, and then shake it.
5 Remove all packing material from the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the photoconductor drum. Doing so may aect the print
quality of future print jobs.
6 Insert the imaging unit into the printer by aligning the arrows on the side rails of the imaging unit with the
arrows on the side rails inside the printer.
Maintaining the printer 257
background
7 Insert the toner cartridge into the printer by aligning the side rails of the cartridge with the arrows on the
side rails inside the printer.
8 Close the multipurpose feeder door and the front cover.
2
1
Maintaining the printer 258
background
Replacing a staple cartridge
1 Open the stapler door.
2 Pull down the latch of the staple cartridge holder, and then pull the holder out of the
finisher.
3 Squeeze both sides of the empty staple case with your fingers, and then remove the staple case from the
cartridge.
1
1
2
Maintaining the printer 259
background
4 Insert the front side of the new staple case into the staple cartridge, and then push the rear side into the
cartridge.
1
2
5 Push the staple cartridge into the finisher until it clicks into place.
6 Close the stapler door.
Cleaning printer parts
Cleaning the printer
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
Notes:
Perform this task after every few months.
Damage to the printer caused by improper handling is not covered by the printer warranty.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Remove paper from the standard bin and multipurpose feeder.
3 Remove any dust, lint, and pieces of paper around the printer using a soft brush or vacuum.
4 Wipe the outside of the printer with a damp, soft, lintfree cloth.
Notes:
Do not use household cleaners or detergents, as they may damage the finish of the printer.
Make sure that all areas of the printer are dry after cleaning.
5 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Maintaining the printer 260
background
Emptying the hole punch box
1 Pull out the hole punch box.
2 Empty the container.
3 Insert the emptied hole punch box back into the finisher until it clicks into place.
Maintaining the printer 261
background
Moving the printer
Moving the printer to another location
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or
more trained personnel to lift it safely.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: When moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal
injury or printer damage:
Make sure that all doors and trays are closed.
Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer.
If the printer has a caster base, then carefully roll it to the new location. Use caution when passing over
thresholds and breaks in flooring.
If the printer does not have a caster base but is configured with optional trays, then lift the printer o the
trays. Do not try to lift the printer and the trays at the same time.
Always use the handholds on the printer to lift it.
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the
options.
Keep the printer in an upright position.
Avoid severe jarring movements.
Make sure that your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.
Make sure that there is adequate clearance around the printer.
Note: Damage to the printer caused by improper moving is not covered by the printer warranty.
Shipping the printer
When shipping the printer, use the original packaging or call the place of purchase for a relocation kit.
Maintaining the printer 262
background
Clearing jams
Carefully select paper and specialty media and load them properly to avoid paper jams. For more information,
see
Avoiding jams” on page 263. If jams occur, then follow the steps outlined in this chapter.
Note: Jam Recovery is set to Auto by default. The printer reprints jammed pages unless the memory
required to hold the pages is needed for other printer tasks.
Avoiding jams
Load paper properly
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.
Correct loading of paper Incorrect loading of paper
Do not remove a tray while the printer is printing.
Do not load a tray while the printer is printing. Load it before printing, or wait for a prompt to load it.
Do not load too much paper. Make sure the stack height is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Clearing jams 263
background
Do not slide the paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.
Make sure the guides in the tray or the multipurpose feeder are properly positioned and are not pressing
tightly against the paper or envelopes.
Push the tray firmly into the printer after loading paper.
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the long
edge of the paper are on the right side of the tray. For more information, see the “Loading paper and specialty
media” section of the User’s Guide.
Allow the paper to enter the optional mailbox bins properly
Make sure to adjust the bin extender so that the paper size indicators match the size of the paper used.
Notes:
If the bin extender is shorter than the size of the paper you are printing on, then the paper causes a
jam in the mailbox bin. For example, if you are printing on a legal-size paper and the bin extender is
set to letter-size, then a jam occurs.
If the bin extender is longer than the size of the paper you are printing on, then the edges become
uneven and the paper is not stacked properly. For example, if you are printing on a letter-size paper
and the bin extender is set to legal-size, then the paper does not stack properly.
Clearing jams 264
background
If paper needs to be returned to the mailbox bin, then insert the paper under the bin arm, and then push
the paper all the way back.
1
2
Note: If the paper is not under the bin arm, then a jam occurs due to an
overfilled
bin.
Use recommended paper
Use only recommended paper or specialty media.
Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, bent, or curled paper.
Flex, fan, and straighten paper or specialty media before loading it.
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.
Do not mix paper sizes, weights, or types in the same tray.
Make sure the paper size and type are set correctly on the computer or printer control panel.
Store paper per manufacturer recommendations.
Identifying jam locations
Notes:
When Jam Assist is set to On, the printer flushes blank or pages with partial prints after a jammed page
has been cleared. Check your printed output for blank pages.
When Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto, the printer reprints jammed pages.
Clearing jams 265
background
Jam locations
1 Staple finisher
2 Standard bin
3 Front door
4 Multipurpose feeder
5 Duplex unit
6 Trays
7 Output expander
8 Rear door
9 Mailbox
10 Staple finisher rear door
Clearing jams 266
background
Paper jam in the front door
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
1 Open the front cover and the multipurpose feeder.
2
1
2 Remove the toner cartridge.
3 Remove the imaging unit.
1
2
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
Clearing jams 267
background
4 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
1
2
5 Insert the imaging unit.
Note: Use the arrows on the side of the printer as a guide.
6 Insert the toner cartridge.
7 Close the multipurpose feeder door and the front cover.
8 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Paper jam in the rear door
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Clearing jams 268
background
1 Open the rear door.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Close the rear door.
Clearing jams 269
background
4 Push the back of the standard tray.
5 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
1
2
6 Insert the standard tray.
7 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Clearing jams 270
background
Paper jam in the standard bin
1 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
2 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Paper jam in the duplex unit
1 Remove the tray.
1
2
3
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
2
1
Clearing jams 271
background
3 Insert the tray.
4 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Paper jam in trays
1 Remove the tray.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Clearing jams 272
background
3 Insert the tray.
4 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Paper jam in the multipurpose feeder
1 Remove paper from the multipurpose feeder.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Flex, fan, and align the paper edges before loading.
Clearing jams 273
background
4 Reload paper, and then adjust the paper guide.
5 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Paper jam in the staple finisher
1 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Clearing jams 274
background
2 Open the rear staple finisher door.
3 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
4 Close the door.
5 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Clearing jams 275
background
Staple jam in the finisher
1 Open the staple access door.
2 Remove the staple cartridge holder.
3 Open the staple guard, and then remove the loose staples.
Clearing jams 276
background
4 Close the staple guard.
5 Press the staples against the metal bracket.
Note: If the staples are at the rear of the cartridge, then shake the cartridge downward to bring the
staples near the metal bracket.
Clearing jams 277
background
6 Insert the staple cartridge holder.
7 Close the staple access door.
8 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Clearing jams 278
background
Paper jam in the output expander
1 Open the rear output expander door.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Close the door.
4 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Clearing jams 279
background
Paper jam in the mailbox
1 Open the rear mailbox door.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Close the door.
4 If the jam is in the mailbox bin, then remove the jammed paper.
Clearing jams 280
background
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
5 If necessary, press on the control panel.
Clearing jams 281
background
Troubleshooting
Understanding the printer messages
Cartridge, imaging unit mismatch [41.xy]
Use only a supported toner cartridge and imaging unit.
Note: For a list of supported supplies, go to
www.lexmark.com.
Change [paper source] to [custom string] load [orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the correct paper size and type in the tray, verify the paper size and type settings are specified
in the Paper menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Tou ch Cancel job to cancel the print job.
Change [paper source] to [custom type name] load [orientation]
Try one or more of the following
Load the correct paper size and type in the tray, verify the paper size and type settings are specified
in the Paper menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Cancel the print job.
Change [paper source] to [paper size] load [orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the correct paper size and type in the tray, verify the paper size and type settings are specified
in the Paper menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Cancel the print job.
Change [paper source] to [paper type] [paper size] load [orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the correct paper size and type in the tray, verify the paper size and type settings are specified
in the Paper menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Cancel the print job.
Troubleshooting 282
background
Check tray [x] connection
Try one or more of the following:
Turn o the printer, and then turn it back on.
If the error occurs a second time, then:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the specified tray.
4 Reattach the tray.
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
6 Turn the printer back on.
If the error occurs again, then:
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the tray.
4 Contact customer support.
To clear the message and resume the job, select Continue on the printer control panel. For non-touch-
screen printer models, press
to confirm.
Close door or insert cartridge
The toner cartridge is missing or not installed properly. Insert the cartridge, and then close all doors and
covers.
Close finisher rear door
Close the finisher rear door of the printer.
Close rear door
Close the rear door of the printer.
Complex page, some data may not have printed [39]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Continue to ignore the message and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Cancel the current print job. For nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.
Install additional printer memory.
Troubleshooting 283
background
Configuration change, some held jobs were not restored [57]
Held jobs are invalidated because of any of the following possible changes in the printer:
The printer firmware has been updated.
The tray for the print job is removed.
The print job is sent from a flash drive that is no longer attached to the USB port.
The printer hard disk contains print jobs that were stored when the hard disk was installed in a dierent
printer model.
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models,
press
to confirm.
Defective flash detected [51]
Try one or more of the following:
Replace the defective flash memory card.
From the printer control panel, select Continue to ignore the message and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Cancel the current print job.
Disk full [62]
Try one or more of the following:
Select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For non-touch-screen printer models,
press
to
confirm.
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the printer hard disk.
Install a printer hard disk with larger capacity.
Disk must be formatted for use in this device
From the printer control panel, select Format disk to format the printer hard disk and clear the message.
Note: Formatting deletes all the files stored in the printer hard disk.
Disk near full. Securely clearing disk space.
Try one or more of the following:
Select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press to confirm.
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the printer hard disk.
Install a hard disk with higher capacity.
Troubleshooting 284
background
Empty the hole punch box
Try one or more of the following:
Empty the hole punch box.
Select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing.
Cancel the print job.
Error reading USB drive. Remove USB.
An unsupported USB device is inserted. Remove the USB device, and then insert a supported one.
Error reading USB hub. Remove hub.
An unsupported USB hub has been inserted. Remove the USB hub, and then install a supported one.
Imaging unit low [84.xy]
You may need to order an imaging unit. If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear
the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Imaging unit nearly low [84.xy]
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Imaging unit very low, [x] estimated pages remain [84.xy]
You may need to replace the imaging unit very soon. For more information, see the "Replacing supplies"
section of the User’s Guide.
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Incompatible output bin [x] [59]
Try one or more of the following:
Remove the indicated bin.
Select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing without using
the
specified
bin. For non-touch-screen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Troubleshooting 285
background
Incompatible tray [x] [59]
Try one or more of the following:
Remove the specified tray.
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing without
using the specified tray. For non-touch-screen printer models, press
to confirm.
Incorrect paper size, open [paper source] [34]
Note: The paper source can be a tray or a feeder.
Try one or more of the following:
Load the correct size of paper in the paper source.
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message and print using a
dierent
paper
source. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Check the length and width guides of the paper source and make sure the paper is loaded properly.
Make sure the correct paper size and type are
specified
in the Printing Preferences or in the Print dialog.
Make sure the paper size and type are
specified
in the Paper menu on the printer control panel.
Make sure that the paper size is correctly set. For example, if Multipurpose Feeder Size or MP Feeder
Size is set to Universal, then make sure the paper is large enough for the data being printed.
Cancel the print job.
Insert hole punch box
Insert the hole punch box into the finisher, and then select Continue on the printer control panel to clear
the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Insert staple cartridge
Try one or more of the following:
Insert a staple cartridge. For more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply.
Select Continue to clear the message and print without using the staple finisher. For non-touch-screen
printer models, press
to confirm.
Insert Tray [x]
Try one or more of the following:
Insert the specified tray into the printer.
Cancel the print job.
Reset the active bin for a linked set of bins by selecting Reset active bin on the printer control panel.
Troubleshooting 286
background
Install bin [x]
Try one or more of the following:
Install the specified bin:
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Install the specified bin.
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
5 Turn the printer back on.
Cancel the print job.
Reset active bin
Install Tray [x]
Try one or more of the following:
Install the specified tray:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Install the specified tray.
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
5 Turn the printer back on.
Cancel the print job.
Reset the active bin.
Insucient memory for Flash Memory Defragment operation [37]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Continue to stop the defragmentation and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Delete fonts, macros, and other data from the printer memory.
Install additional printer memory.
Insucient memory, some Held Jobs were deleted [37]
The printer deleted some held jobs in order to process current jobs.
Select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press
to confirm.
Troubleshooting 287
background
Insucient memory, some held jobs will not be restored [37]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer
models, press
to
confirm.
Delete other held jobs to free up additional printer memory.
Insucient
memory to collate job [37]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Continue to print the part of the job already stored and begin
collating the rest of the print job. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Cancel the current print job.
Insucient
memory to support Resource Save feature [35]
Install additional printer memory or select Continue on the printer control panel to disable Resource Save,
clear the message, and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Load [paper source] with [custom string] [paper orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.
To use the tray that has the correct size or type of paper, select Finished loading paper on the printer
control panel. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Note: If the printer
finds
a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that
tray. If the printer cannot
find
a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the
default paper source.
Cancel the current job.
Load [paper source] with [custom type name] [paper orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.
To use the tray that has the correct size or type of paper, select Finished loading paper on the printer
control panel. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Note: If the printer finds a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that
tray. If the printer cannot
find
a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the
default paper source.
Cancel the current job.
Troubleshooting 288
background
Load [paper source] with [paper size] [paper orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size of paper.
To use the tray or feeder that has the correct size of paper, select Finished loading paper on the printer
control panel. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Note: If the printer finds a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that
tray. If the printer cannot find a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the
default paper source.
Cancel the current job.
Load [paper source] with [paper type] [paper size] [paper orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.
To use the tray or feeder that has the correct size and type of paper, select Finished loading paper on
the printer control panel. For nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Note: If the printer
finds
a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that
tray. If the printer cannot find a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the
default paper source.
Cancel the current job.
Load multipurpose feeder with [custom string] [orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the feeder with the correct paper size and type.
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press to clear the message and continue
printing.
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder, the printer manually overrides the request, and then prints
from an automatically selected tray.
Cancel the current job.
Load multipurpose feeder with [custom type name] [orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the multipurpose feeder with the correct paper size and type.
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press to clear the message and continue
printing.
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder, the printer manually overrides the request, and then prints
from an automatically selected tray.
Cancel the current job.
Troubleshooting 289
background
Load multipurpose feeder with [paper size] [orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the multipurpose feeder with the correct paper size.
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press to clear the message and continue
printing.
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder, the printer manually overrides the request, and then prints
from an automatically selected tray.
Cancel the current job.
Load multipurpose feeder with [paper type] [paper size] [orientation]
Try one or more of the following:
Load the multipurpose feeder with the correct paper size and type.
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press to clear the message and continue
printing.
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder, the printer manually overrides the request, and then prints
from an automatically selected tray.
Cancel the current job.
Load staples
Try one or more of the following:
Replace or insert the specified staple cartridge in the finisher.
Select Continue to clear the message and continue printing.
Cancel the print job.
Maintenance kit low [80.xy]
You may need to order a maintenance kit. For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web site at
http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support, and then report the message.
If necessary, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer
models, press
to confirm.
Maintenance kit nearly low [80.xy]
For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web site at http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer
support, and then report the message.
If necessary, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer
models, press
to confirm.
Troubleshooting 290
background
Maintenance kit very low [80.xy]
You may need to replace the maintenance kit very soon. For more information, contact customer support
at
http://support.lexmark.com or your service representative.
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Memory full [38]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Cancel job to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer
models, press
to confirm.
Install additional printer memory.
Misfeed cleared, extra sheets in output bin [24y.xx]
Select Continue on the control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen
printer models, press
to confirm.
Network [x] software error [54]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Continue to continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer
models, press
to
confirm.
Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer back on.
Update the network firmware in the printer or print server. For more information, visit the Lexmark
support Web site at
http://support.lexmark.com.
NonLexmark [supply type], see User’s Guide [33.xy]
Note: The supply type can be toner cartridge or imaging unit.
The printer has detected a nonLexmark supply or part installed in the printer.
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-
party supplies or parts may aect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging
components. For more information, see
“Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies” on page 250.
All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts and may deliver unpredictable
results if third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended life may
damage your Lexmark printer or associated components.
Warning—Potential Damage: Use of third-party supplies or parts can aect warranty coverage.
Damage caused by the use of third-party supplies or parts may not be covered by the warranty.
To accept any and all of these risks and to proceed with the use of non-genuine supplies or parts in your
printer, press and hold
and the # button on the control panel simultaneously for 15 seconds.
Troubleshooting 291
background
For nontouchscreen printer models, press and on the control panel simultaneously for 15 seconds
to clear the message and continue printing.
If you do not want to accept these risks, then remove the third-party supply or part from your printer and
install a genuine Lexmark supply or part.
Note: For a list of supported supplies, see the “Ordering supplies” section or go to
www.lexmark.com.
Not enough free space in
flash
memory for resources [52]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to confirm.
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the flash memory.
Upgrade to a larger capacity flash memory card.
Note: Downloaded fonts and macros that are not previously stored in the
flash
memory are deleted.
Paper changes needed
Try one or more of the following:
Select Use current supplies on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing.
For non-touch-screen printer models, press
to confirm.
Cancel the current print job.
Parallel port [x] disabled [56]
Try one or more of the following:
Select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press to
confirm.
The printer discards any data received through the parallel port.
Select Reset active bin to reset the bin for a linked set of bins.
Printer had to restart. Last job may be incomplete.
Select Continue on the control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen
printer models, press
to confirm.
For more information, go to
http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support.
Troubleshooting 292
background
Reattach bin [x]
Try one or more of the following:
Turn o the printer, and then turn it back on.
Reattach the specified bin.
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the specified bin.
4 Reattach the bin.
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
6 Turn the printer back on.
Remove the
specified
bin:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the
specified
bin.
4 Contact customer support.
Select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and print without using the specified
bin. For non-touch-screen printer models, press
to confirm.
Reattach bins [x] – [y]
Try one or more of the following:
Turn o the printer, and then turn it back on.
Reattach the specified bins:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the specified bins.
4 Reattach the bins.
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
6 Turn the printer back on.
Remove the
specified
bins:
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the
specified
bins.
4 Contact customer support.
Select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and print without using the specified
bins. For non-touch-screen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Troubleshooting 293
background
Reinstall missing or unresponsive cartridge [31.xy]
Try one or more of the following:
Check if the toner cartridge is missing. If missing, then install the toner cartridge.
For information on installing the toner cartridge, see the “Replacing supplies” section.
If the toner cartridge is installed, then remove and reinstall the unresponsive toner cartridge.
Note: If the message appears after reinstalling the supply, then replace the toner cartridge. The
cartridge may be defective or a nongenuine Lexmark supply. For more information, see
“Using
genuine Lexmark parts and supplies” on page 250.
Reinstall missing or unresponsive imaging unit [31.xy]
Try one or more of the following:
Check if the imaging unit is missing. If missing, then install the imaging unit.
For information on installing the imaging unit, see the “Replacing supplies” section.
If the imaging unit is installed, then remove and reinstall the unresponsive imaging unit.
Note: If the message appears after reinstalling the supply, then replace the imaging unit. The
imaging unit may be defective or a nongenuine Lexmark supply. For more information, see
“Using
genuine Lexmark parts and supplies” on page 250.
Remove defective disk [61]
Remove and replace the defective printer hard disk.
Remove packaging material, [area name]
1 Remove any remaining packaging material from the specified location.
2 Select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models,
press
to confirm.
Remove paper from all bins
Bins have reached their capacity. Remove paper from all bins to clear the message and continue printing.
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then select Continue on the printer control panel. For
non-touch-screen printer models, press
to confirm.
Remove paper from bin [x]
Remove paper from the specified bin. The printer automatically detects paper removal and resumes printing.
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then select Continue on the printer control panel. For
non-touch-screen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Troubleshooting 294
background
Remove paper from [linked set bin name]
Remove paper from the specified bin. The printer automatically detects paper removal and resumes printing.
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then select Continue on the printer control panel. For
non-touch-screen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Remove paper from standard output bin
Remove the paper stack from the standard bin. The printer automatically detects paper removal and
resumes printing.
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then select Continue on the printer control panel. For
non-touch-screen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Replace cartridge, printer region mismatch [42.xy]
Install a toner cartridge that matches the region number of the printer. x indicates the value of the printer
region. y indicates the value of the cartridge region. x and y can have the following values:
List of printer and toner cartridge regions
Region number Region
0Global
1 United States, Canada
2 European Economic Area (EEA), Switzerland
3 Asia Pacific, Australia, New Zealand
4Latin America
5 Africa, Middle East, rest of Europe
9 Invalid
Notes:
The x and y values are the .xy of the error code shown on the printer control panel.
The x and y values must match for printing to continue.
Replace defective imaging unit [31.xy]
Replace the defective imaging unit to clear the message. For more information, see the instruction sheet
that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the
User’s Guide or visit
www.lexmark.com.
Troubleshooting 295
background
Replace imaging unit, 0 estimated pages remain [84.xy]
Replace the imaging unit to clear the message and continue printing. For more information, see the
instruction sheet that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the
User’s Guide or visit
www.lexmark.com.
Replace maintenance kit, recommended life exceeded [80.xyz]
For more information, go to http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support.
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press
to clear the message and continue printing.
Replace maintenance kit to resume printing [80.xy]
For more information, go to http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support, and then report the
message.
If necessary, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer
models, press
to
confirm.
Replace missing cartridge [31.xy]
Install the missing toner cartridge to clear the message. For more information, see the “Replacing supplies”
section of the User’s Guide.
Replace missing fuser [31.xyz]
Install the missing fuser. For more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the replacement part.
Replace missing imaging unit [31.xy]
Install the missing imaging unit to clear the message. For more information, see the “Replacing supplies”
section of the User’s Guide.
Replace roller kit [81.xx]
1 Replace the roller kit. For more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the part.
2 Press to clear the message and continue printing.
Replace unsupported cartridge [32.xy]
Remove the toner cartridge, and then install a supported one to clear the message and continue printing.
For more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply.
Troubleshooting 296
background
This error can also be caused by installing a genuine Lexmark cartridge, such as a high yield cartridge, that
is not intended to be used in this product.
The following error codes indicate that a nongenuine Lexmark toner cartridge is installed:
32.13
32.16
32.19
32.22
32.25
32.28
32.31
32.34
32.37
For more information, see
“Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies” on page 250.
Note: If you do not have a replacement cartridge, then see the “Ordering supplies” section or go to
www.lexmark.com.
Replace unsupported imaging unit [32.xy]
Remove the imaging unit, and then install a supported one to clear the message and continue printing. For
more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply.
This error can also be caused by installing a genuine Lexmark imaging unit, such as a MICR unit, that is not
intended to be used in this product.
The following error codes indicate that a nongenuine Lexmark imaging unit is installed:
32.14
32.17
32.20
32.23
32.26
32.29
32.32
32.35
32.38
For more information, see
“Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies” on page 250.
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section or go to
www.lexmark.com.
Replace wiper
1 Replace the fuser wiper. For more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the part.
2 Select Continue on the control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen
printer models, press
to confirm.
Troubleshooting 297
background
Restore held jobs?
Try one or more of the following:
Select Restore on the printer control panel to restore all held jobs stored in the printer hard disk. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Select Do not restore if you do not want any print jobs to be restored. For nontouchscreen printer
models, press
to confirm.
Serial port [x] disabled [56]
Try one or more of the following:
Select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press to confirm.
The printer discards any data received through the
specified
serial port.
Select Reset active bin to reset the active bin for a linked set of bins.
Make sure the Serial
Buer
menu is set to Enabled.
Some held jobs were not restored
Select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.
Note: Held jobs that are not restored remain in the printer hard disk and are inaccessible.
Standard network software error [54]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control panel, select Continue to continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer
models, press
to
confirm.
Turn o the printer and then turn it back on.
Update the network firmware in the printer or print server. For more information, visit the Lexmark
support Web site at
http://support.lexmark.com.
Standard USB port disabled [56]
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models,
press
to
confirm.
Notes:
The printer discards any data received through the USB port.
Make sure the USB
Buer
menu is not set to Disabled.
Troubleshooting 298
background
Supply needed to complete job
A supply needed to complete the job is missing. Cancel the current job.
The device is operating in Safe Mode. Some print options may be disabled
or provide unexpected results.
Select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.
Too many bins attached [58]
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the extra bins.
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
5 Turn the printer back on.
Too many disks installed [58]
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the extra printer hard disks.
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
5 Turn the printer back on.
Too many
flash
options installed [58]
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the extra
flash
memory.
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
5 Turn the printer back on.
Too many trays attached [58]
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
3 Remove the extra trays.
Troubleshooting 299
background
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
5 Turn the printer back on.
Tray [x] paper size unsupported
The paper size in the specified tray is unsupported. Replace it with a supported paper size.
Unformatted flash detected [53]
Try one or more of the following:
From the printer control, select Continue to stop the defragmentation and continue printing. For
nontouchscreen printer models, press
to
confirm.
Format the
flash
memory.
Note: If the error message remains, then the flash memory may be defective and need to be replaced.
Unsupported disk
1 Remove the unsupported disk, and then install a supported one.
2 Select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouch screen printer models,
press
to confirm.
Unsupported option in slot [x] [55]
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.
3 Remove the unsupported option card from the printer controller board, and then replace it with a
supported card.
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
5 Turn the printer back on.
USB port [x] disabled [56]
Try one or more of the following:
Select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press to
confirm.
The printer discards any data received through the specified serial port.
Select Reset active bin to reset the active bin for a linked set of bins.
Make sure the USB Buer menu is enabled.
Troubleshooting 300
background
Solving printer problems
“Printer does not respond” on page 301
“Printing problems” on page 303
“Hardware and internal option problems” on page 312
“Paper feed problems” on page 316
“Print quality problems” on page 318
Printer does not respond
The printer is not responding
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure the printer is turned on.
Is the printer turned on?
Go to step 2. Turn on the printer.
Step 2
Check if the printer is in Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.
Is the printer in Sleep mode or Hibernate mode?
Press the Sleep
button to wake the
printer from Sleep
mode or Hibernate
mode.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check if one end of the power cord is plugged into the printer and
the other to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded
electrical outlet?
Go to step 4. Plug one end of the
power cord into the
printer and the other
to a properly
grounded electrical
outlet.
Step 4
Check other electrical equipment plugged into the electrical outlet.
Does other electrical equipment work?
Unplug the other
electrical equipment,
and then turn on the
printer. If the printer
does not work, then
reconnect the other
electrical equipment.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
Check if the cables connecting the printer and the computer are
inserted in the correct ports.
Are the cables inserted in the correct ports?
Go to step 6. Make sure to match
the following:
The USB symbol
on the cable with
the USB symbol
on the printer
The appropriate
Ethernet cable
with the Ethernet
port
Troubleshooting 301
background
Action Yes No
Step 6
Make sure the electrical outlet is not turned o by a switch or
breaker.
Is the electrical outlet turned o by a switch or breaker?
Turn on the switch or
reset the breaker.
Go to step 7.
Step 7
Check if the printer is plugged into any surge protectors,
uninterruptible power supplies, or extension cords.
Is the printer plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible
power supplies, or extension cords?
Connect the printer
power cord directly
to a properly
grounded electrical
outlet.
Go to step 8.
Step 8
Check if one end of the printer cable is plugged into a port on the
printer and the other to the computer, print server, option, or other
network device.
Is the printer cable securely attached to the printer and the
computer, print server, option, or other network device?
Go to step 9. Connect the printer
cable securely to the
printer and the
computer, print
server, option, or
other network
device.
Step 9
Make sure to install all hardware options properly and remove any
packing material.
Are all hardware options properly installed and all packing material
removed?
Go to step 10. Turn o the printer,
remove all packing
materials, then
reinstall the
hardware options,
and then turn on the
printer.
Step 10
Check if you have selected the correct port settings in the printer
driver.
Are the port settings correct?
Go to step 11. Use correct printer
driver settings.
Step 11
Check the installed printer driver.
Is the correct printer driver installed?
Go to step 12. Install the correct
printer driver.
Step 12
Turn o the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn
the printer back on.
Is the printer working?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 302
background
Printer display is blank
Action Yes No
Step 1
Press the Sleep button on the printer control panel.
Does Ready appear on the printer display?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Turn o the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn
the printer back on.
Do Please wait and Ready appear on the printer display?
The problem is
solved.
Turn o the printer,
and then contact
customer support.
Printing problems
Confidential and other held documents do not print
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the control panel, check if the documents appear in the
Held Jobs list.
Note: If the documents are not listed, then print the
documents using the Print and Hold options.
b Print the documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
The print job may contain a formatting error or invalid data.
Delete the print job, and then send it again.
For PDF files, generate a new file, and then print the
documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Troubleshooting 303
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
If you are printing from the Internet, then the printer may be reading
the multiple job titles as duplicates.
For Windows users
a Open the Printing Preferences dialog.
b From the Print and Hold section, select Keep duplicate
documents.
c Enter a PIN.
d Resend the print job.
For Macintosh users
a Save and name each job dierently.
b Send the job individually.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Delete some held jobs to free up printer memory.
b Resend the print job.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Add printer memory.
b Resend the print job.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Envelope seals when printing
Action Yes No
a Use envelopes that have been stored in a dry environment.
Note: Printing on envelopes with high moisture content can
seal the flaps.
b Resend the print job.
Does the envelope seal when printing?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 304
background
Error message about reading the flash drive appears
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check if the flash drive is inserted into the front USB slot.
Note: The flash drive will not work if it is inserted into the rear
USB slot.
Is the
flash
drive inserted into the front USB slot?
Go to step 2. Insert the flash drive
into the front USB
slot.
Step 2
Check if the indicator light on the printer control panel is blinking
green.
Note: A green blinking light indicates that the printer is busy.
Is the indicator light blinking green?
Wait until the printer
is ready, then view
the held jobs list, and
then print the
documents.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Check for an error message on the display.
b Clear the message.
Does the error message still appear?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
Check if the flash drive is supported.
For more information on tested and approved USB flash drives,
see
“Supported
flash
drives and
file
types” on page 68 for
nontouchscreen printer models.
For touchscreen printer models, see
“Supported flash drives
and file types” on page 116 and “Supported flash drives and file
types” on page 164.
Does the error message still appear?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
Check if the USB slot is disabled by the system support person.
Does the error message still appear?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 305
background
Incorrect characters print
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure the printer is not in Hex Trace mode.
Note: If Ready Hex appears on the printer display, then turn o
the printer, and then turn it back on to deactivate Hex Trace
mode.
Is the printer in Hex Trace mode?
Deactivate Hex
Trace mode.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a From the printer control panel, select Standard Network or
Network [x], and then set SmartSwitch to On.
b Resend the print job.
Do incorrect characters print?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if you are printing on paper that is supported by the tray.
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, set the paper
size and type to match the paper loaded in the tray.
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, open Printing
Preferences or the Print dialog, and then specify the paper type.
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Check if the trays are not linked.
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 306
background
Large jobs do not collate
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the Finishing menu on the printer control panel, set
Collate to (1,2,3) (1,2,3).
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print and collate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a From the printer software, set Collate to (1,2,3) (1,2,3).
Note: Setting Collate to (1,1,1) (2,2,2) in the software overrides
the setting in the Finishing menu.
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print and collate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Reduce the complexity of the print job by eliminating the number
and size of fonts, the number and complexity of images, and the
number of pages in the job.
Did the job print and collate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Multiplelanguage PDF files do not print
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the print options for the PDF output are set to embed
all fonts.
b Generate a new PDF file, and then resend the print job.
Do the files print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Open the document you want to print in Adobe Acrobat.
b Click File > Print > Advanced > Print As Image > OK > OK .
Do the files print?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 307
background
Print job takes longer than expected
Action Yes No
Step 1
Change the environmental settings of the printer.
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:
Settings > General Settings
b Select EcoMode or Quiet Mode, and then select O.
Note: Disabling Eco-Mode or Quiet Mode may increase the
consumption of energy or supplies, or both.
Did the job print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Reduce the number and size of fonts, the number and complexity
of images, and the number of pages in the print job, and then
resend the job
Did the job print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Remove held jobs stored in the printer memory.
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Disable the Page Protect feature.
From the printer control panel, navigate to:
Settings > General Settings > Print Recovery > Page Protect
> O
b Resend the print job.
Did the job print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
Install additional printer memory, and then resend the print job.
Did the job print?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 308
background
Print jobs do not print
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the document you are trying to print, open the Print dialog
and check if you have selected the correct printer.
Note: If the printer is not the default printer, then you must
select the printer for each document that you want to print.
b Resend the print job.
Do the jobs print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check if the printer is plugged in and turned on, and if Ready
appears on the printer display.
b Resend the print job.
Do the jobs print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
If an error message appears on the printer display, then clear the
message.
Note: The printer continues to print after clearing the message.
Do the jobs print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Check if the ports (USB, serial, or Ethernet) are working and if
the cables are securely connected to the computer and the
printer.
Note: For more information, see the setup documentation
that came with the printer.
b Resend the print job.
Do the jobs print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the
printer back on.
b Resend the print job.
Do the jobs print?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 6.
Step 6
a Remove, and then reinstall the printer software. For more
information, see
“Installing the printer software” on page 35.
Note: The printer software is available at
http://support.lexmark.com.
b Resend the print job.
Do the jobs print?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 309
background
Printing slows down
Notes:
When printing using narrow paper, the printer prints at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the
fuser.
The printer speed may be reduced when printing for long periods of time, or printing at elevated
temperatures.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure the size of the paper loaded in the tray matches the
fuser type.
Note: Use a 110-volt fuser for printing on letter-size paper and
a 220-volt fuser for printing on A4size paper.
b Resend the print job.
Does the print speed increase?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Replace the fuser. For more information on installing the fuser,
see the instruction sheet that came with the part.
b Resend the print job.
Does the print speed increase?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Tray linking does not work
Notes:
The trays can detect paper length.
The multipurpose feeder does not automatically detect the paper size. You must set the size from the
Paper Size/Type menu.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Open the trays, and then check if they contain paper of the
same size and type.
Check if the paper guides are in the correct positions for
the size of the paper loaded in each tray.
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are
aligned with the paper size indicators on the tray.
b Resend the print job.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshooting 310
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the trays to be
linked.
Note: The paper size and type must match for trays to be
linked.
b Resend the print job.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Unexpected page breaks occur
Action Yes No
Step 1
Adjust the print timeout settings.
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:
Settings > General Settings > Timeouts > Print Timeout
b Select a higher setting and then, depending on your printer
model, select
or Submit.
c Resend the print job.
Did the file print correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check the original file for manual page breaks.
b Resend the print job.
Did the file print correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 311
background
Hardware and internal option problems
2100-sheet tray problems
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Pull out the tray, and then do one or more of the following:
Make sure paper lies
flat
in the tray.
Check for paper jams or misfeeds.
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are
aligned with the paper size indicators on the tray.
Check if the paper guides are aligned against the edges of
the paper.
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill
indicator.
Check if you are printing on a recommended paper size and
type.
Check if the paper or specialty media meets specifications
and is not damaged.
b Insert the tray properly.
Note: Press the paper stack down while inserting the tray.
Does the tray operate properly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Turn o the printer, then wait about 10 seconds, and then turn it
back on.
Does the tray operate properly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Print a menu settings page, and then check if the tray is listed in
the Installed Features list.
Note: If the tray is listed in the menu settings page, but paper
jams when it enters or exits the tray, then it may not be properly
installed.
Is the tray listed in the menu settings page?
Go to step 4. For more
information, see the
setup sheet that
came with the 2100-
sheet tray.
Step 4
Check if the tray is available in the printer driver.
Note: You may need to manually add the tray in the printer driver
to make it available for print jobs. For more information, see
Adding available options in the print driver” on page 35.
Is the tray available in the printer driver?
Go to step 5. Manually add the
tray in the printer
driver.
Troubleshooting 312
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
Check if the tray is selected.
From the application you are using, select the tray. If you are
using Mac OS X version 9, then make sure the printer is set up
in Chooser.
Does the tray operate properly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot detect internal option
Action Yes No
Step 1
Turn o the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn
on the printer.
Does the internal option operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check if the internal option is properly installed in the controller
board.
a Turn o the printer using the power switch, and then unplug the
power cord from the electrical outlet.
b Make sure the internal option is installed in the appropriate
connector in the controller board.
c Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly
grounded electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
Is the internal option properly installed in the controller board?
Go to step 3. Connect the internal
option to the
controller board.
Step 3
Print a menu settings page, and then check to see if the internal
option is listed in the Installed Features list.
Is the internal option listed in the menu settings page?
Go to step 4. Reinstall the internal
option.
Step 4
a Check if the internal option is selected.
It may be necessary to manually add the internal option in the
printer driver to make it available for print jobs. For more
information, see
Adding available options in the print driver”
on page 35.
b Resend the print job.
Does the internal option operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 313
background
Internal print server does not operate correctly
Action Yes No
Step 1
Reinstall the internal print server.
a Remove, and then install the internal print server. For more
information, see
“Installing an Internal Solutions Port” on
page 17.
b Print a menu settings page, and then check if the internal print
server is listed in the Installed Features list.
Is the internal print server listed in the Installed Features list?
Go to step 2. Check if the internal
print server is
supported by the
printer.
Note: An internal
print server from
another printer may
not work with this
printer.
Step 2
Check the cable and the internal print server connection.
Use the correct cable, and then check if it is securely connected
to the internal print server.
Does the internal print server operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Internal Solutions Port does not operate correctly
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure the Internal Solutions Port (ISP) is installed.
a Install the ISP. For more information, see “Installing an Internal
Solutions Port” on page 17.
b Print a menu settings page, and then check if the ISP is listed
in the Installed Features list.
Is the ISP listed in the Installed Features list?
Go to step 2. Check if you have a
supported ISP.
Note: An ISP from
another printer may
not work on this
printer.
Step 2
Check the cable and the ISP connection.
a Use the correct cable, and then make sure it is securely
connected to the ISP.
b Check if the ISP solution interface cable is securely connected
into the receptacle of the controller board.
Note: The ISP solution interface cable and the receptacle on
the controller board are colorcoded.
Does the Internal Solutions Port operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 314
background
Tray problems
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Pull out the tray, and then do one or more of the following:
Check for paper jams or misfeeds.
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are
aligned with the paper size indicators on the tray.
If you are printing on customsize paper, then make sure
that the paper guides rest against the edges of the paper.
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill
indicator.
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.
b Check if the tray closes properly.
Is the tray working?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Turn o the printer, then wait about 10 seconds, and then turn
the printer back on.
b Resend the print job.
Is the tray working?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check if the tray is installed and recognized by the printer.
Print a menu settings page, and then check if the tray is listed
in the Installed Features list.
Is the tray listed in the menu settings page?
Go to step 4. Reinstall the tray. For
more information,
see the setup
documentation that
came with the tray.
Step 4
Check if the tray is available in the printer driver.
Note: If necessary, manually add the tray in the printer driver to
make it available for print jobs. For more information, see
Adding available options in the print driver” on page 35.
Is the tray available in the printer driver?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 315
background
USB/parallel interface card does not operate correctly
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure the USB or parallel interface card is installed.
a Install the USB or parallel interface card. For more information,
see
“Installing an Internal Solutions Port” on page 17.
b Print a menu settings page, and then check if the USB or parallel
interface card is listed in the Installed Features list.
Is the USB or parallel interface card listed in the Installed Features
list?
Go to step 2. Check if you have a
supported USB or
parallel interface
card.
Note: A USB or
parallel interface
card from another
printer may not work
on this printer.
Step 2
Check the cable and the USB or parallel interface card connection.
Use the correct cable, and then make sure it is securely
connected to the USB or parallel interface card.
Does the USB or parallel interface card operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Paper feed problems
Jammed pages are not reprinted
Action Yes No
a Turn on jam recovery.
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
Settings > General Settings > Print Recovery > Jam
Recovery
2 Select On or Auto.
3 Depending on your printer model, press or touch
Submit.
b Resend the pages that did not print.
Were the jammed pages reprinted?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 316
background
Paper frequently jams
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Pull out the tray, and then do one or more of the following:
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are
aligned with the paper size indicators on the tray.
Check if the paper guides are aligned against the edges of
the paper.
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill
indicator.
Check if you are printing on a recommended paper size and
type.
b Insert the tray properly.
If jam recovery is enabled, then the print jobs will reprint
automatically.
Do paper jams still occur frequently?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Resend the print job.
Do paper jams still occur frequently?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Review the tips on avoiding jams. For more information, see
Avoiding jams” on page 263.
b Follow the recommendations, and then resend the print job.
Do paper jams still occur frequently?
Contact customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Paper jam message remains after jam is cleared
Action Yes No
a Do either of the following:
For touchscreen printer models, touch or Done.
For nontouchscreen printer models, select Next > >
Clear the jam, press OK >
.
b Follow the instructions on the printer display.
Does the paper jam message remain?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 317
background
Print quality problems
Characters have jagged or uneven edges
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Print a font sample list to check if the fonts you are using are
supported by the printer.
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:
Menus > Reports > Print Fonts
2 Select PCL Fonts or PostScript Fonts.
b Resend the print job.
Are you using fonts that are supported by the printer?
Go to step 2. Select a font that is
supported by the
printer.
Step 2
Check if the fonts installed on the computer are supported by the
printer.
Are the fonts installed on the computer supported by the printer?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Clipped pages or images
Leading edge
Trailing edge
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct
positions for the paper loaded.
b Resend the print job.
Is the page or image clipped?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 318
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the
Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Do the paper size and type match the paper loaded in the tray?
Go to step 3. Do one or more of
the following:
Specify the paper
size from the tray
settings to match
the paper loaded
in the tray.
Change the
paper loaded in
the tray to match
the paper size
specified in the
tray settings.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Is the page or image clipped?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Reinstall the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge.
2 Remove the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
3 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Is the page or image clipped?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Compressed images appear on prints
Note: Printing on letter-size paper using a 220-volt fuser compresses images.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure the size of the paper loaded in the tray matches the
fuser type.
Note: Use a 110-volt fuser for printing on letter-size paper and
a 220-volt fuser for printing on A4size paper.
b Resend the print job.
Do compressed images still appear?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshooting 319
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Replace the fuser. For more information on installing the fuser,
see the instruction sheet that came with the part.
b Resend the print job.
Do compressed images still appear?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Gray background on prints
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
Leading edge
Trailing edge
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the Quality Menu on the printer control panel, decrease
the toner darkness.
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.
b Resend the print job.
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Reinstall the imaging unit and the toner cartridge.
a Remove the toner cartridge.
b Remove the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit
to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure
to light can cause print quality problems.
c Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
d Resend the print job.
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 320
background
Horizontal voids appear on prints
Leading edge
Trailing edge
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure your software program is using a correct fill pattern.
b Resend the print job.
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Load the specified tray or feeder with a recommended type of
paper.
b Resend the print job.
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 321
background
Incorrect margins on prints
ABC
DEF
ABC
DEF
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct
positions for the paper size loaded.
b Resend the print job.
Are the margins correct?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper size in the Paper menu
to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Does the paper size match the paper loaded in the tray?
Go to step 3. Do one or more of
the following:
Specify the paper
size from the tray
settings to match
the paper loaded
in the tray.
Change the
paper loaded in
the tray to match
the paper size
specified
in the
tray settings.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Are the margins correct?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 322
background
Paper curl
Action Yes No
Step 1
Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct
positions for the size of the paper loaded.
Are the width and length guides positioned correctly?
Go to step 2. Adjust the width and
length guides.
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Do the paper type and weight match the type and weight of the
paper in the tray?
Go to step 3. Specify the paper
type and weight from
the tray settings to
match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Is the paper still curled?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Remove the paper from the tray, and then turn it over.
b Resend the print job.
Is the paper still curled?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Resend the print job.
Is the paper still curled?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Print irregularities
) )
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
Leading edge
Trailing edge
Troubleshooting 323
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct
positions for the size of the paper loaded in the tray.
b Resend the print job.
Do print irregularities still appear?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the
Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Do the printer settings match the type and weight of the paper
loaded in the tray?
Go to step 3. Specify the paper
size and type from
the tray settings to
match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Do print irregularities still appear?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
Check if the paper loaded in the tray has texture or rough finishes.
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?
From the printer
control panel, set the
paper texture in the
Paper menu to match
the paper loaded in
the tray.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Resend the print job.
Do print irregularities still appear?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Step 6
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Do print irregularities still appear?
Contact
customer
support at
http://support.lexm
ark.com or your
service
representative.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 324
background
Print is too dark
ABC
DEF
ABC
DEF
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the Quality menu on the printer control panel, reduce the
toner darkness.
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still too dark?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a From the printer control panel, set the paper type, texture and
weight in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
b Resend the print job.
Is the tray set to the type, texture, and weight of the paper loaded?
Go to step 3. Do one or more of
the following:
Specify the paper
type, texture, and
weight from the
tray settings to
match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Change the
paper loaded in
the tray to match
the paper type,
texture and
weight specified
in the tray
settings.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type,
texture and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print
dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still too dark?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
Check if the paper loaded in the tray has texture or rough finishes.
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?
From the printer
control panel,
change the texture
settings in the Paper
Texture menu to
match the paper you
are printing on.
Go to step 5.
Troubleshooting 325
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still too dark?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Step 6
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Is the print still too dark?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Print is too light
ABC
DEF
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the Quality menu on the printer control panel, increase
the toner darkness.
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still too light?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper type, texture, and
weight in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Is the tray set to the type, texture, and weight of the paper loaded?
Go to step 3. Change the paper
type, texture, and
weight to match the
paper loaded in the
tray.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type,
texture, and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print
dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still too light?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 326
background
Action Yes No
Step 4
Make sure that the paper has no texture or rough finishes.
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?
From the printer
control panel,
change the texture
settings in the Paper
Texture menu to
match the paper you
are printing on.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still too light?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Step 6
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
3 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still too light?
Go to step 7. The problem is
solved.
Step 7
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Is the print still too light?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Printer is printing blank pages
Troubleshooting 327
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if there is packing material left on the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
2 Check if the packing material is properly removed from the
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Is the printer still printing blank pages?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Is the printer still printing blank pages?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Is the printer still printing blank pages?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Printer is printing solid black pages
Troubleshooting 328
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Reinstall the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Is the printer printing solid black pages?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Is the printer printing solid black pages?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Repeating defects appear on prints
)
)
)
)
)
)
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Replace the imaging unit if the distance between the defects is
equal to any of the following:
47.8 mm (1.88 in.)
96.8 mm (3.81 in.)
28.5 mm (1.12 in.)
b Resend the print job.
Do repeating defects still appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Replace the fuser if the distance between the defects is equal
to either of the following:
94.25 mm (3.71 in.)
95.2 mm (3.75 in.)
b Resend the print job.
Do repeating defects still appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 329
background
Shadow images appear on prints
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
Leading edge
Trailing edge
Action Yes No
Step 1
Load paper with the correct paper type and weight in the tray.
Is paper with the correct paper type and weight loaded in the tray?
Go to step 2. Load paper with the
correct paper type
and weight in the
tray.
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Is the tray set to the type and weight of the paper loaded?
Go to step 3. Change the paper
loaded in the tray to
match the paper type
and weight specified
in the tray settings.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Do shadow images still appear on prints?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Do shadow images still appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Skewed print
) )
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
Troubleshooting 330
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct
positions for the size of the paper loaded.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still skewed?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Check if you are printing on a paper that is supported by the
tray.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print still skewed?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Streaked horizontal lines appear on prints
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the tray or feeder
from Printing Preferences or the Print dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Do the paper type and weight match the type and weight of the
paper in the tray?
Go to step 3. Change the paper
type and weight to
match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Step 3
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Resend the print job.
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 331
background
Action Yes No
Step 4
a Reinstall the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Streaked vertical lines appear on prints
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
Leading edge
Trailing edge
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type,
texture, and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print
dialog.
b Resend the print job.
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 332
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
From the printer control panel, set the paper texture, type, and
weight in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Do the paper texture, type, and weight match the paper in the tray?
Go to step 3. Do one or more of
the following:
Specify the paper
texture, type, and
weight from the
tray settings to
match the paper
loaded in the tray.
Change the
paper loaded in
the tray to match
the paper
texture, type, and
weight specified
in the tray
settings.
Step 3
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Resend the print job.
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Reinstall the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support at
http://support.lexm
ark.com or your
service
representative.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 333
background
Toner fog or background shading appears on prints
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Reinstall the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Did the toner fog or background shading disappear from the
prints?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Did the toner fog or background shading disappear from the
prints?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Toner rubs o
Leading edge
Trailing edge
ABC
DEF
Troubleshooting 334
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, check the paper
type, texture, and weight.
Do the paper type, texture, and weight match the paper loaded in
the tray?
Go to step 2. Specify the paper
type, texture, and
weight from the tray
settings to match the
paper loaded in the
tray.
Step 2
Resend the print job.
Does the toner still rub o?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Toner specks appear on prints
Action Yes No
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Do toner specks appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Transparency print quality is poor
Action Yes No
Step 1
From the printer control panel, set the paper type in the Paper
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Is the paper type for the tray set to Transparency?
Go to step 2. Set the paper type to
Transparency.
Step 2
a Check if you are using a recommended type of transparency.
b Resend the print job.
Is the print quality still poor?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Uneven print density
Troubleshooting 335
background
Action Yes No
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Is the print density uneven?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Vertical voids appear on prints
Leading edge
Trailing edge
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure your software program is using a correct fill pattern.
b Resend the print job.
Do vertical voids appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight
in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.
b Resend the print job.
Do vertical voids appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
Check if you are using a recommended type of paper.
a Load the specified tray or feeder with a recommended type of
paper.
b Resend the print job.
Do vertical voids appear on prints?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging
unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.
b Resend the print job.
Do vertical voids appear on prints?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshooting 336
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.
Do vertical voids appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Solving home screen application problems
This troubleshooting section applies only to touch-screen printer models.
An application error has occurred
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check the system log for relevant details.
a Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in
the address field.
If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then you can:
View the IP address on the printer home screen.
Print a network setup page or the menu settings pages, and
then locate the IP address in the TCP/IP section.
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
b Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > System tab >
Log.
c From the Filter menu, select an application status.
d From the Application menu, select an application, and then
click Submit.
Does an error message appear in the log?
Go to step 2. Contact customer
support.
Step 2
Resolve the error.
Is the application working now?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 337
background
Embedded Web Server does not open
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure the printer IP address is correct.
View the printer IP address:
From the printer home screen
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page,
and then finding the TCP/IP section
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated
by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
Is the printer IP address correct?
Go to step 2. Type the correct
printer IP address in
the address field of
your Web browser.
Note: Depending on
the network
settings, you may
need to type
https://” instead
of “http://” before
the printer IP
address to access
the Embedded Web
Server.
Step 2
Check if the printer is turned on.
Is the printer turned on?
Go to step 3. Turn on the printer.
Step 3
Check if the network connection is working.
Is the network connection working?
Go to step 4. Contact your system
support person.
Step 4
Make sure the cable connections to the printer and print server are
secure.
For more information, see the setup documentation that came
with the printer.
Are the cable connections to the printer and print server secure?
Go to step 5. Tighten the cable
connection.
Step 5
Temporarily disable the Web proxy servers.
Note: Proxy servers may block or restrict you from accessing
certain Web sites including the Embedded Web Server.
Are the Web proxy servers disabled?
Go to step 6. Contact your system
support person.
Step 6
Access the Embedded Web Server again by typing the correct IP
address in the address field.
Did the Embedded Web Server open?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshooting 338
background
Contacting customer support
Before contacting customer support, make sure to have the following information:
Printer problem
Error message
Printer model type and serial number
Go to
http://support.lexmark.com to receive email or chat support, or browse through the library of manuals,
support documentation, drivers, and other downloads.
Technical support via telephone is also available. In the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-539-6275. For other countries
or regions, go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
Troubleshooting 339
background
Notices
Product information
Product name:
Lexmark MS810de, MS810dn, MS810n, MS811dn, MS811n, MS812de, MS812dn, MS817dn, MS817n, MS818dn
Machine type:
4063
Model(s):
210, 230, 23E, 410, 430, 630, 63E
Edition notice
September 2022
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local
law: LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC., PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of
express or implied warranties in certain transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made
to the information herein; these changes will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the
products or the programs described may be made at any time.
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to
make these available in all countries in which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is
not intended to state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be used. Any functionally
equivalent product, program, or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be
used instead. Evaluation and
verification
of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services,
except those expressly designated by the manufacturer, are the user’s responsibility.
For Lexmark technical support, visit
http://support.lexmark.com.
For information on supplies and downloads, visit
www.lexmark.com.
© 2017 Lexmark International, Inc.
All rights reserved.
GOVERNMENT END USERS
The Software Program and any related documentation are "Commercial Items," as that term is
defined
in 48
C.F.R. 2.101, "Computer Software" and "Commercial Computer Software Documentation," as such terms are
used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 or 48 C.F.R. 227.7202, as applicable. Consistent with 48 C.F.R. 12.212 or 48 C.F.R.
227.7202-1 through 227.7207-4, as applicable, the Commercial Computer Software and Commercial Software
Documentation are licensed to the U.S. Government end users (a) only as Commercial Items and (b) with only
those rights as are granted to all other end users pursuant to the terms and conditions herein.
Notices 340
background
Trademarks
Lexmark, the Lexmark logo, MarkNet, and MarkVision are trademarks or registered trademarks of Lexmark
International, Inc. in the United States and/or other countries.
Google Cloud Print is a trademark of Google Inc.
Mac and the Mac logo are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Microsoft and Windows are either registered trademarks or trademarks of the Microsoft group of companies
in the United States and other countries.
Mopria®, the Mopria® logo, and the Mopria® Alliance logo are registered trademarks and service marks of Mopria
Alliance, Inc. in the United States and other countries. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited.
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard Company. PCL is Hewlett-Packard Company’s
designation of a set of printer commands (language) and functions included in its printer products. This printer
is intended to be compatible with the PCL language. This means the printer recognizes PCL commands used
in various application programs, and that the printer emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.
The following terms are trademarks or registered trademarks of these companies:
Albertus The Monotype Corporation plc
Antique Olive Monsieur Marcel OLIVE
Apple-Chancery Apple Computer, Inc.
Arial The Monotype Corporation plc
CG Times Based on Times New Roman under license from The Monotype Corporation plc, is a
product of Agfa Corporation
Chicago Apple Computer, Inc.
Clarendon Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries
Eurostile Nebiolo
Geneva Apple Computer, Inc.
GillSans The Monotype Corporation plc
Helvetica Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries
Hoefler Jonathan Hoefler Type Foundry
ITC Avant Garde Gothic International Typeface Corporation
ITC Bookman International Typeface Corporation
ITC Mona Lisa International Typeface Corporation
ITC Zapf Chancery International Typeface Corporation
Joanna The Monotype Corporation plc
Marigold Arthur Baker
Monaco Apple Computer, Inc.
New York Apple Computer, Inc.
Oxford Arthur Baker
Notices 341
background
Palatino Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries
Stempel Garamond Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries
Tay Agfa Corporation
Times New Roman The Monotype Corporation plc
Univers Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
AirPrint and the AirPrint logo are trademarks of Apple, Inc.
Licensing notices
All licensing notices associated with this product can be viewed from the root directory of the installation
software CD.
Noise emission levels
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in conformance with ISO
9296.
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA
Printing 57 (MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n,
MS811dn, MS812dn, MS817n,
MS817dn, and MS818dn); 58
(MS810de and MS812de)
Ready 32 (all models)
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.
Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) directive
The WEEE logo signifies specific recycling programs and procedures for electronic products in countries of the
European Union. We encourage the recycling of our products.
If you have further questions about recycling options, visit the Lexmark Web site at
www.lexmark.com for your
local sales oce phone number.
Notices 342
background
India E-Waste notice
This product complies with the India E-Waste (Management and Handling) Rules, 2011, which prohibit use of
lead, mercury, hexavalent chromium, polybrominated biphenyls, or polybrominated diphenyl ethers in
concentrations exceeding 0.1 by weight and 0.01% by weight for cadmium, except for the exemption set in
Schedule II of the Rules.
Product disposal
Do not dispose of the printer or supplies in the same manner as normal household waste. Consult your local
authorities for disposal and recycling options.
Static sensitivity notice
This symbol identifies static-sensitive parts. Do not touch the areas near these symbols without first touching
a metal surface in an area away from the symbol.
ENERGY STAR
Any Lexmark product bearing the ENERGY STAR
®
emblem on the product or on a start-up screen is certified to
comply with Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) ENERGY STAR requirements as configured when shipped
by Lexmark.
Temperature information
Ambient operating temperature 15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)
Shipping temperature -40 to 43.3°C (-40 to 110°F)
Storage temperature and relative humidity 1 to 35°C (34 to 95°F)
8 to 80% RH
Notices 343
background
Laser notice
The printer is
certified
in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR Chapter I, Subchapter J for
Class I (1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements
of IEC 60825-1: 2014.
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The printer contains internally a Class IIIb (3b) laser
that is nominally a 15milliwatt gallium arsenide laser operating in the wavelength of 787–800 nanometers. The
laser system and printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I
level during normal operation, user maintenance, or prescribed service condition.
Laser advisory label
A laser notice label may be axed to this printer as shown:
DANGER - Invisible laser radiation when cartridges are removed and interlock defeated. Avoid exposure to laser beam.
PERIGO - Radiação a laser invisível será liberada se os cartuchos forem removidos e o lacre rompido. Evite a exposição aos feixes de laser.
Opasnost - Nevidljivo lasersko zračenje kada su kasete uklonjene i poništena sigurnosna veza. Izbjegavati izlaganje zracima.
NEBEZPEČÍ - Když jsou vyjmuty kazety a je odblokována pojistka, ze zařízení je vysíláno neviditelné laserové záření. Nevystavujte se působení laserového paprsku.
FARE - Usynlig laserstråling, når patroner ernes, og spærreanordningen er slået fra. Undgå at blive udsat for laserstrålen.
GEVAAR - Onzichtbare laserstraling wanneer cartridges worden verwijderd en een vergrendeling wordt genegeerd. Voorkom blootstelling aan de laser.
DANGER - Rayonnements laser invisibles lors du retrait des cartouches et du déverrouillage des loquets. Eviter toute exposition au rayon laser.
VAARA - Näkymätöntä lasersäteilyä on varottava, kun värikasetit on poistettu ja lukitus on auki. Vältä lasersäteelle altistumista.
GEFAHR - Unsichtbare Laserstrahlung beim Herausnehmen von Druckkassetten und oener Sicherheitssperre. Laserstrahl meiden.
ΚΙΝΔΥΝΟΣ - Έκλυση αόρατης ακτινοβολίας laser κατά την αφαίρεση των κασετών και την απασφάλιση της μανδάλωσης. Αποφεύγετε την έκθεση στην
ακτινοβολία laser.
VESZÉLY – Nem látható lézersugárzás fordulhat elő a patronok eltávolításakor és a zárószerkezet felbontásakor. Kerülje a lézersugárnak való kitettséget.
PERICOLO - Emissione di radiazioni laser invisibili durante la rimozione delle cartucce e del blocco. Evitare l´esposizione al raggio laser.
FARE – Usynlig laserstråling når kassettene tas ut og sperren er satt ut av spill. Unngå eksponering for laserstrålen.
NIEBEZPIECZEŃSTWO - niewidzialne promieniowanie laserowe podczas usuwania kaset i blokady. Należy unikać naświetlenia promieniem lasera.
ОПАСНО! Невидимое лазерное излучение при извлеченных картриджах и снятии блокировки. Избегайте воздействия лазерных лучей.
Pozor – Nebezpečenstvo neviditeľného laserového žiarenia pri odobratých kazetách a odblokovanej poistke. Nevystavujte sa lúčom.
PELIGRO: Se producen radiaciones láser invisibles al extraer los cartuchos con el interbloqueo desactivado. Evite la exposición al haz de láser.
FARA – Osynlig laserstrålning när patroner tas ur och spärrmekanismen är upphävd. Undvik exponering för laserstrålen.
- 当移除碳粉盒及互失效生看不的激光射,避免暴露在激光光束下。
危險 - 移除碳粉匣與安全連續開關失效時會生看不見的雷射輻射。請避免曝露在雷射光束下。
危険 - カートリッジが
取り外され
、内部ロックが
無効になると
、見えないレーザー
光が放射されます
このレーザー光に当たらないようにしてください。
Power consumption
Product power consumption
The following table documents the power consumption characteristics of the product.
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.
Mode Description Power consumption (Watts)
Printing The product is generating hardcopy output
from electronic inputs.
670 (MS810n, MS810dn, MS817n, and MS817dn);
700 (MS810de); 770 (MS811n, MS811dn, and
MS818dn); 830 (MS812dn and MS812de)
Notices 344
background
Mode Description Power consumption (Watts)
Copy The product is generating hardcopy output
from hardcopy original documents.
N/A
Scan The product is scanning hardcopy documents. N/A
Ready The product is waiting for a print job. Ready 1: 55 (MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn,
MS812dn, MS817n, MS817dn, and MS818dn); 60
(MS810de and MS812de); Ready 2: 30 (All printer
models)
Sleep Mode The product is in a highlevel energysaving
mode.
2.9 (MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn,
MS817n, MS817dn, and MS818dn); 3.3 (MS810de);
3.7 (MS812de)
Hibernate The product is in a lowlevel energysaving
mode.
0.5 (MS810n, MS810dn, MS811n, MS811dn, MS812dn,
MS810de, MS817n, MS817dn, and MS818dn); 0.6
(MS812de)
O The product is plugged into an electrical outlet,
but the power switch is turned o.
0.1
The power consumption levels listed in the previous table represent time-averaged measurements.
Instantaneous power draws may be substantially higher than the average.
Values are subject to change. See
www.lexmark.com for current values.
Sleep Mode
This product is designed with an energy-saving mode called Sleep Mode. The Sleep Mode saves energy by
lowering power consumption during extended periods of inactivity. The Sleep Mode is automatically engaged
after this product is not used for a
specified
period of time, called the Sleep Mode Timeout.
Factory default Sleep Mode Timeout for this product (in minutes): 20
By using the configuration menus, the Sleep Mode Timeout can be modified between 1 minute and 120 minutes.
Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a low value reduces energy consumption, but may increase the response
time of the product. Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a high value maintains a fast response, but uses more
energy.
Hibernate Mode
This product is designed with an ultralow power operating mode called Hibernate mode. When operating in
Hibernate Mode, all other systems and devices are powered down safely.
The Hibernate mode can be entered in any of the following methods:
Using the Hibernate Timeout
Using the Schedule Power modes
Using the Sleep/Hibernate button
Factory default Hibernate Timeout for this product in all countries or regions 3 days
The amount of time the printer waits after a job is printed before it enters Hibernate mode can be modified
between one hour and one month.
Notices 345
background
O mode
If this product has an o mode which still consumes a small amount of power, then to completely stop product
power consumption, disconnect the power supply cord from the electrical outlet.
Total energy usage
It is sometimes helpful to calculate the total product energy usage. Since power consumption claims are
provided in power units of Watts, the power consumption should be multiplied by the time the product spends
in each mode in order to calculate energy usage. The total product energy usage is the sum of each mode's
energy usage.
Applicability of Regulation (EU) 2019/2015 and (EU) 2019/2020
Per Commission Regulation (EU) 2019/2015 and (EU) 2019/2020, the light source contained within this product
or its component is intended to be used for Image Capture or Image Projection only, and is not intended for
use in other applications.
Patent acknowledgment
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual
Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Elliptic Curve Cryptography (ECC) Cipher
Suites for Transport Layer Security (TLS) implemented in the product or service.
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual
Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for TLS Elliptic Curve Cipher Suites with
SHA-256/382 and AES Galois Counter Mode (GCM) implemented in the product or service.
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual
Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for TLS Suite B Profile for Transport Layer Security
(TLS) implemented in the product or service.
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual
Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Addition of the Camellia Cipher Suites to
Transport Layer Security (TLS) implemented in the product or service.
The use of certain patents in this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in
the Intellectual Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for AES-CCM ECC Cipher Suites
for TLS implemented in the product or service.
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual
Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for IKE and IKEv2 Authentication Using the Eliptic
Curve Digital Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) implemented in the product or service.
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual
Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Suite B Cryptographic Suites for IPSec
implemented in the product or service.
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual
Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Algorithms for Internet Key Exchange version
1 (IKEv1) implemented in the product or service.
Notices 346
background
Multiple model information
The following information applies to all MS810, MS811, MS812, MS817, and MS818 printer models except for the
MS812de printer model.
STATEMENT OF LIMITED WARRANTY FOR LEXMARK LASER PRINTERS,
LEXMARK LED PRINTERS, AND LEXMARK MULTIFUNCTION LASER
PRINTERS
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY
This limited warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S., refer to the
country-specific
warranty information that came with your product.
This limited warranty applies to this product only if it was originally purchased for your use, and not for resale,
from Lexmark or a Lexmark Remarketer, referred to in this statement as “Remarketer.
Limited warranty
Lexmark warrants that this product:
—Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which perform like new parts
—Is, during normal use, free from defects in material and workmanship
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a Remarketer or Lexmark for
repair or replacement (at Lexmark's option).
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or option is used with the
product for which it was intended. To obtain warranty service, you may be required to present the feature or
option with the product.
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this statement is available to
that user for the remainder of the warranty period. You should transfer proof of original purchase and this
statement to that user.
Limited warranty service
The warranty period starts on the date of original purchase as shown on the purchase receipt and ends 12
months later provided that the warranty period for any supplies and for any maintenance items included with
the printer shall end earlier if it, or its original contents, are substantially used up, depleted, or consumed. Fuser
Units, Transfer/Transport Units, Paper Feed items, if any, and any other items for which a Maintenance Kit is
available are substantially consumed when the printer displays a “Life Warning” or “Scheduled Maintenance”
message for such item.
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase. You may be required to
deliver your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark
designated location. You are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the
Lexmark designated location.
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced becomes the property of
the Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or repaired item.
Notices 347
background
The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the original product.
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced, altered, in need of a
repair not included in warranty service, damaged beyond repair, or if the product is not free of all legal
obligations, restrictions, liens, and encumbrances.
As part of your warranty service and/or replacement, Lexmark may update the firmware in your printer to the
latest version. Firmware updates may modify printer settings and cause counterfeit and/or unauthorized
products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces to stop working. Authorized
use of genuine Lexmark products will not be impacted.
Before you present this product for warranty service, remove all print cartridges, programs, data, and removable
storage media (unless directed otherwise by Lexmark).
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark authorized servicer in your area
contact Lexmark on the World Wide Web.
Remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty period. For products no longer
covered by a Lexmark warranty, technical support may not be available or only be available for a fee.
Extent of limited warranty
Lexmark does not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of any product or the durability or longevity of
prints produced by any product.
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:
—Modification or unauthorized attachments
—Accidents, misuse, abuse or use inconsistent with Lexmark user’s guides, manuals, instructions or guidance
—Unsuitable physical or operating environment
—Maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer
—Operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle
—Use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications
—Refurbishment, repair,
refilling
or remanufacture by a third party of products, supplies or parts
—Products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces not furnished by Lexmark
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER LEXMARK NOR ITS THIRD PARTY SUPPLIERS
OR REMARKETERS MAKE ANY OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED, WITH RESPECT TO THIS PRODUCT, AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND
SATISFACTORY QUALITY. ANY WARRANTIES THAT MAY NOT BE DISCLAIMED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW
ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL
APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD. ALL INFORMATION, SPECIFICATIONS, PRICES, AND SERVICES ARE SUBJECT
TO CHANGE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT NOTICE.
Limitation of liability
Your sole remedy under this limited warranty is set forth in this document. For any claim concerning performance
or nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer for this product under this limited warranty, you may recover
actual damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the amount you paid for the
product that caused the damages. This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or
Notices 348
background
damage to real property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. IN NO EVENT WILL
LEXMARK BE LIABLE FOR ANY LOST PROFITS, LOST SAVINGS, INCIDENTAL DAMAGE, OR OTHER
ECONOMIC OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES. This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a Remarketer of the
possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any claim by you based on a third party claim.
This limitation of remedies also applies to claims against any Suppliers and Remarketers of Lexmark. Lexmark's
and its Suppliers' and Remarketers' limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such Suppliers and Remarketers
are intended beneficiaries of this limitation.
Additional rights
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not allow the exclusion or
limitation of incidental or consequential damages, so the limitations or exclusions contained above may not
apply to you.
This limited warranty gives you specific legal rights. You may also have other rights that vary from state to state.
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information
statement
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part
15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
The FCC Class B limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the
equipment is operated in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful
interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a
particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which
can be determined by turning the equipment o and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference
by one or more of the following measures:
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit dierent from that to which the receiver is connected.
Consult your point of purchase or service representative for additional suggestions.
The manufacturer is not responsible for radio or television interference caused by using other than
recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment. Unauthorized changes
or
modifications
could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class B computing
device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach
or 1021294 for USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a
violation of FCC regulations.
Notices 349
background
Any questions regarding this compliance information statement should be directed to:
Director of Lexmark Technology & Services
Lexmark International, Inc.
740 West New Circle Road
Lexington, KY 40550
(859) 232–3000
Industry Canada compliance statement
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment
Standard ICES-003.
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’industrie du Canada
Cet appareil numérique de classe B est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux
équipements pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.
日本の VCCI 規定
製品にこのマークが
表示されている場合
、次の要件を満たしています。
この装置
、クラス B 情報技術装置
です
。この装置
、家庭環境で使用することを
目的としていますが
、この
装置がラジオやテレビジョン受信機に近接して使用されると、受信障害を引き起こすことがあります。
取扱説明書に従って正しい取り扱いをしてください。
VCCI-B
European Community (EC) directives conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2014/30/EU, 2014/35/EU,
2009/125/EC, and 2011/65/EU on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States
relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage
limits, the ecodesign of energy-related products, and on the restrictions of use of certain hazardous substances
in electrical and electronic equipment.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön
fasor, Millennium Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the
Directives is available upon request from the Authorized Representative or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/european-union-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class B limits of EN 55022 and EN55032 and safety requirements of EN 609501 or
EN 62368-1.
Notices 350
background
Modelspecific information
The following information applies only to the MS812de printer model.
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information
statement
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part
15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the
equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful
interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful
interference, in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by using other than
recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or
modifications
to this equipment. Unauthorized changes
or modifications could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class A computing
device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach
or 1021294 for USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a
violation of FCC regulations.
Industry Canada compliance statement
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment
Standard ICES-003.
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’industrie du Canada
Cet appareil numérique de classe A est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux
équipements pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.
Japanese VCCI notice
Notices 351
background
European Community (EC) directives conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2014/30/EU, 2014/35/EU,
and 2011/65/EU on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to
electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits, and
on the restrictions of use of certain hazardous substances in electrical and electronic equipment.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön
fasor, Millennium Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the
Directives is available upon request from the Authorized Representative or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/european-union-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and EN55032 and safety requirements of EN 609501 or
EN 62368-1.
Radio interference notice
Warning
This is a product that complies with the emission requirements of EN55022 and EN55032 Class A limits and
immunity requirements of EN55024. This product is not intended to be used in residential/domestic
environments.
This is a Class A product. In a domestic environment, this product may cause radio interference, in which case
the user may be required to take adequate measures.
Notices 352
background
Index
Numerics
2100sheet tray
loading 52, 100, 149
550sheet tray
installing 30
A
accessing the Embedded Web
Server 89, 137
accessing the remote control
panel
Embedded Web Server 72
Active NIC menu 202
adding hardware options
print driver 35
adding internal options
print driver 35
adjusting printer display
brightness 247
adjusting Sleep
mode 77, 124, 173
adjusting toner
darkness 66, 114, 163
administrator settings
Embedded Web
Server 72, 120, 168
AirPrint
using 69, 117, 165
AppleTalk menu 207
applications
home screen 90, 138
attaching cables 33
available internal options 12
avoiding jams 182
avoiding paper jams 263
B
Background and Idle Screen
using 90, 138
Bin Setup menu 200
buttons, printer control
panel 43, 85
buttons, touch screen
using 88, 134
C
cables
Ethernet 33
USB 33
canceling a print job
from a computer 72, 119, 168
from the printer control
panel 71, 119, 168
cannot open Embedded Web
Server 338
card stock
loading 59, 107, 156
tips 178
Cartridge, imaging unit mismatch
[41.xy] 282
Change [paper source] to
[custom string] load
[orientation] 282
Change [paper source] to
[custom type name] load
[orientation] 282
Change [paper source] to [paper
size] load [orientation] 282
Change [paper source] to [paper
type] [paper size] load
[orientation] 282
Check tray [x] connection 283
checking an unresponsive
printer 301
checking status of parts and
supplies 75, 122, 171
checking the status of parts and
supplies 75, 122, 171
checking the virtual display
using the Embedded Web
Server 120, 168
checking virtual display
using the Embedded Web
Server 168
cleaning
exterior of the printer 260
interior of the printer 260
cleaning the printer 260
clearing jams
duplex unit 271
Close door or insert
cartridge 283
Close
finisher
rear door 283
Close rear door 283
Complex page, some data may
not have printed [39] 283
compressed images appear on
prints 319
confidential data
information on
securing 82, 129, 177
confidential
jobs
modifying print
settings 73, 121, 169
confidential
print
jobs 70, 118, 166
Confidential Print menu 217
Configuration change, some held
jobs were not restored [57] 284
configuration
information
wireless network 36
configurations
printer 41, 83, 130
Configure MP menu 193
configuring
multiple printers 74, 121, 170
supply
notifications,
imaging
unit 72, 120, 168
supply notifications,
maintenance kit 72, 120, 168
supply
notifications,
toner
cartridge 72, 120, 168
configuring supply
notifications
120, 168
configuring
supply
notifications
from the Embedded Web
Server 72
connecting to a wireless network
using PBC, Push Button
Configuration method 38
using PIN, Personal
Identification
Number
method 38
using the Embedded Web
Server 39
using wireless setup wizard 37
conservation settings
brightness, adjusting 247
EcoMode 75, 123, 171
Hibernate mode 77, 124, 173
Quiet mode 76, 123, 172
Index 353
background
Sleep Mode 124
Sleep mode 77, 173
conserving supplies 248
contacting customer
support 339
control panel, printer
indicator light 44, 86, 133
Sleep button light 44, 86, 133
controller board
accessing 12
creating custom name
paper type 112
Custom Bin Names menu 199
Custom Names menu 198
custom paper type
assigning 65, 162
custom paper type name
assigning 113
creating 64, 161
Custom Type [x]
assigning a paper type 65
changing name 161
creating custom name 112
Custom Type [x] name
creating 64
Custom Types menu 198
customer support
contacting 339
D
Default Source menu 190
Defective flash detected [51] 284
device and network settings
erasing 80
device and network settings
information
erasing 127, 175
directory list
printing 71, 119, 167
Disk full [62] 284
Disk must be formatted for use in
this device 284
Disk near full. Securely clearing
disk space. 284
disk wiping 80, 127, 176
display troubleshooting
printer display is blank 303
display, printer control
panel 43, 85
adjusting brightness 247
disposing of printer hard
disk 78, 125, 174
documents, printing
from a computer 66, 113, 162
from a mobile
device 69, 70, 117
E
EcoMode setting 75, 123, 171
EcoSettings
about 91
understanding 139
Edit Security Setups menu 215
embedded solutions
erasing 80
embedded solutions information
erasing 127, 175
Embedded Web Server
accessing 89, 137
accessing the remote control
panel 72
adjusting brightness 247
administrator
settings 72, 120, 168
checking the status of
parts 75, 122, 171
checking the status of
supplies 75, 122, 171
copying settings to other
printers 74, 121, 170
modifying
confidential
print
settings 73, 121, 169
networking
settings 72, 120, 168
problem accessing 338
Embedded Web Server
Administrator's Guide
where to find 129, 177
Embedded Web Server —
Security: Administrator's Guide
where to find 72, 120, 168
Embedded Web Server —
Security: Administrator’s Guide
where to find 82
emission
notices 342, 349, 350, 351
Empty the hole punch box 285
emptying the hole punch
box 261
encrypting the printer hard
disk 81, 128, 176
envelopes
loading 59, 107, 156
tips on using 178
environmental settings
EcoMode 75, 123, 171
Hibernate mode 77, 124, 173
printer display brightness,
adjusting 247
Quiet mode 76, 123, 172
Sleep Mode 124
Sleep mode 77, 173
Erase Temporary Data Files
menu 217
erasing hard disk
memory 80, 127, 176
erasing nonvolatile
memory 80, 127, 175
erasing volatile
memory 79, 126, 175
Error reading USB drive. Remove
USB. 285
Error reading USB hub. Remove
hub. 285
Ethernet network
preparing to set up for Ethernet
printing 36
Ethernet port 33
Ethernet setup
preparing for an 36
exporting a configuration
using the Embedded Web
Server 92, 140
F
factory defaults
restoring 124, 173
factory defaults, restoring 78
FCC notices 349, 351
finding more information about
the printer 8
finding printer IP address 89, 137
finisher
finishing
features 185
supported paper sizes 185
finisher features 185
Finishing menu 233
firmware
card 12
flash drive
printing from 67, 115, 163
flash drives
supported file types 68, 116, 164
font sample list
printing 71, 119, 167
forms
printing 114, 162
Index 354
background
Forms and Favorites
setting up 91, 139
G
General Settings menu 220
Google Cloud Print
using 69, 117, 165
green settings
EcoMode 75, 123, 171
Hibernate mode 77, 124, 173
Quiet mode 76, 123, 172
H
hardware options, adding
print driver 35
held jobs 70, 118, 166
printing from a Macintosh
computer 71, 118, 167
printing from
Windows 71, 118, 167
held print jobs
printing from a Macintosh
computer 71, 118, 167
printing from
Windows 71, 118, 167
Help menu 245
Hibernate mode
using 77, 124, 173
hiding icons on the home
screen 90, 138
hole punch box
emptying 261
Home button
printer control panel 43, 85, 132
home screen
buttons, understanding 86, 133
customizing 90, 138
hiding icons 90, 138
showing icons 90, 138
home screen applications
configuring 90, 138
finding information 90, 138
home screen buttons
understanding 86, 133
HTML menu 244
I
icons on the home screen
hiding 90, 138
showing 90, 138
Image menu 245
imaging unit
ordering 252
Imaging unit low [84.xy] 285
Imaging unit nearly low
[84.xy] 285
Imaging unit very low, [x]
estimated pages remain
[84.xy] 285
importing a configuration
using the Embedded Web
Server 92, 140
Incompatible output bin [x]
[59] 285
Incompatible tray [x] [59] 286
Incorrect paper size, open [paper
source] [34] 286
indicator light 132
printer control panel 43, 85
individual settings
erasing 80
individual settings information
erasing 127, 175
Insert hole punch box 286
Insert staple cartridge 286
Insert Tray [x] 286
Install bin [x] 287
Install Tray [x] 287
installing an Internal Solutions
Port 17
installing an optional card 22
installing options
order of installation 29
installing printer hard disk 23
installing the printer software 35
Insucient memory for Flash
Memory Defragment operation
[37] 287
Insucient memory to collate job
[37] 288
Insucient memory to support
Resource Save feature [35] 288
Insucient memory, some Held
Jobs were deleted [37] 287
Insucient memory, some held
jobs will not be restored [37] 288
internal options 12
internal options, adding
print driver 35
internal print server
troubleshooting 314
Internal Solutions Port
installing 17
troubleshooting 314
IP address of computer
finding 89, 137
IP address, printer
finding 89, 137
IPv6 menu 206
J
jams
avoiding 263
locating jam areas 265
locations 265
jams, clearing
expander door 279
front door 267
mailbox 280
multipurpose feeder 273
rear door 268
standard bin 271
staple access door 276
staple finisher 274
trays 272
Job Accounting menu 236
K
keypad
printer control panel 43, 85, 132
L
labels, paper
tips 179
letterhead
loading, 2100sheet
tray 52, 100, 149
loading, multipurpose
feeder 59, 107, 156
loading, trays 45, 93, 142
Lexmark Mobile Print
using 70
Lexmark Print
using 117, 166
linking trays 64, 112, 113, 161, 162
Load [paper source] with [custom
string] [paper orientation] 288
Load [paper source] with [custom
type name] [paper
orientation] 288
Load [paper source] with [paper
size] [paper orientation] 289
Index 355
background
Load [paper source] with [paper
type] [paper size] [paper
orientation] 289
Load multipurpose feeder with
[custom string] [orientation] 289
Load multipurpose feeder with
[custom type name]
[orientation] 289
Load multipurpose feeder with
[paper size] orientation] 290
Load multipurpose feeder with
[paper type] [paper size]
[orientation] 290
Load staples 290
loading
2100sheet tray 52, 100, 149
card stock 59, 107, 156
envelopes 59, 107, 156
letterhead in 2100sheet
tray 52, 100, 149
letterhead in multipurpose
feeder 59, 107, 156
letterhead in trays 45, 93, 142
multipurpose
feeder 59, 107, 156
optional 250sheet
tray 45, 93, 142
optional 550sheet
tray 45, 93, 142
standard 250sheet tray 45
standard 550sheet tray 45, 93
standard tray 142
transparencies 59, 107, 156
lock, security 78, 125, 174
M
maintenance kit
ordering 252
Maintenance kit low [80.xy] 290
Maintenance kit nearly low
[80.xy] 290
Maintenance kit very low
[80.xy] 291
memory
types installed on
printer 78, 125, 174
memory card 12
installing 16
Memory full [38] 291
menu settings
loading on multiple
printers 74, 121, 170
menu settings page
printing 74, 122, 170
menus
Active NIC 202
AppleTalk 207
Bin Setup 200
Confidential Print 217
Configure MP 193
Custom Bin Names 199
Custom Names 198
Custom Types 198
Default Source 190
Edit Security Setups 215
Erase Temporary Data Files 217
Finishing 233
General Settings 220
Help 245
HTML 244
Image 245
IPv6 206
Job Accounting 236
list of 189
Miscellaneous 216
Network [x] 202
Network Card 204
Network Reports 204
Paper Loading 197
Paper Size/Type 190
Paper Texture 194
Paper Weight 195
Parallel [x] 209
PCL Emul 239
PDF 239
PostScript 239
PPDS 242
Print Settings 229
Quality 236
Reports 201
Security Audit Log 218
Serial [x] 212
Set Date and Time 218
Setup 231
SMTP Setup menu 214
Standard Network 202
Standard USB 208
Substitute Size 193
TCP/IP 205
Universal Setup 199
Utilities 238
Wireless 206
XPS 238
Miscellaneous menu 216
Misfeed cleared, extra sheets in
output bin [24y.xx] 291
mobile device
printing
from 69, 70, 117, 165, 166
Mopria Print Service
using 69, 117, 165
moving the printer 10, 11, 262
multipurpose feeder
loading 59, 107, 156
N
Network [x] menu 202
Network [x] software error
[54] 291
Network Card menu 204
Network Reports menu 204
network settings
Embedded Web
Server 72, 120, 168
network setup page
printing 75, 122, 170
Networking Guide
where to find 72, 120, 168
noise emission levels 342
noise, printer
reducing 76, 123
NonLexmark [supply type], see
User’s Guide [33.xy] 291
nonvolatile memory 78, 125, 174
erasing 80, 127, 175
Not enough free space in flash
memory for resources [52] 292
notices 342, 343, 344, 345, 346,
347, 349, 350, 351
number of remaining pages
estimate 250
O
optional 250sheet tray
loading 45, 93, 142
optional 550sheet tray
loading 45, 93, 142
optional card
installing 22
options
550sheet tray, installing 30
firmware cards 12
Internal Solutions Port,
installing 17
memory card 12, 16
Index 356
background
printer hard disk, installing 23
printer hard disk, removing 27
ordering
imaging unit 252
maintenance kit 252
roller kit 252
staple cartridges 252
ordering supplies
toner cartridges 250
P
paper
characteristics 180
letterhead 181
preprinted forms 181
recycled 181
selecting 181
setting size 44
setting type 44
storing 180, 182
unacceptable 181
Universal size
setting 44, 93, 141
using recycled 247
Paper changes needed 292
paper characteristics 180
paper feed troubleshooting
message remains after jam is
cleared 317
paper jam in the duplex unit 271
paper jam in the expander
door 279
paper jam in the front door 267
paper jam in the mailbox 280
paper jam in the multipurpose
feeder 273
paper jam in the rear door 268
paper jam in the standard
bin 271
paper jam in the staple
finisher 274
paper jam in trays 272
paper jam, clearing
duplex unit 271
expander door 279
front door 267
mailbox 280
multipurpose feeder 273
rear door 268
standard bin 271
staple access door 276
staple finisher 274
trays 272
paper jams
avoiding 263
Paper Loading menu 197
paper size
setting 93, 141
Paper Size/Type menu 190
paper sizes
supported 183
Paper Texture menu 194
paper type
setting 93, 141
paper types
supported 183
Paper Weight menu 195
paper weights
supported 183
Parallel [x] menu 209
Parallel port [x] disabled [56] 292
parts
checking status 75, 122, 171
checking, from printer control
panel 122
checking, on the printer control
panel 171
checking, using the Embedded
Web Server 75, 122, 171
using genuine Lexmark 250
parts and supplies, status of
checking, on printer control
panel 75
PCL Emul menu 239
PDF menu 239
Personal Identification Number
method
using 38
PostScript menu 239
PPDS menu 242
preparing to set up the printer on
an Ethernet network 36
print driver
hardware options, adding 35
print irregularities 323
print job
canceling from the printer
control panel 71
canceling, from
computer 72, 119, 168
print quality troubleshooting
blank pages 327
characters have jagged
edges 318
clipped pages or images 318
compressed images appear on
prints 319
gray background on prints 320
horizontal voids appear on
prints 321
print irregularities 323
print is too dark 325
print is too light 326
printer is printing solid black
pages 328
repeating defects appear on
prints 329
shadow images appear on
prints 330
skewed print 330
streaked horizontal lines appear
on prints 331
streaked vertical lines 332
toner fog or background
shading appears on prints 334
toner rubs o 334
toner specks appear on
prints 335
transparency print quality is
poor 335
uneven print density 335
white streaks 336
Print Settings menu 229
print troubleshooting
confidential and other held
documents do not print 303
envelope seals when
printing 304
error reading flash drive 305
incorrect characters print 306
incorrect margins on prints 322
jammed pages are not
reprinted 316
job prints from wrong tray 306
job prints on wrong paper 306
jobs do not print 309
Large jobs do not collate 307
multiplelanguage PDF files do
not print 307
paper curl 323
paper frequently jams 317
print job takes longer than
expected 308
tray linking does not work 310
unexpected page breaks
occur 311
Index 357
background
printer
configurations 41, 83, 130
finishing features 185
minimum clearances 10, 11
models 41, 83, 130
moving 10, 11, 262
selecting a location 10, 11
shipping 262
printer control panel
adjusting brightness 247
factory defaults,
restoring 78, 124, 173
indicator light 44, 86, 133
parts 43, 85, 132
Sleep button light 44, 86, 133
using 43, 85, 132
printer control panel, virtual
display
using the Embedded Web
Server 120
Printer had to restart. Last job
may be incomplete. 292
printer hard disk
disposing of 78, 125, 174
encrypting 81, 128, 176
installing 23
removing 27
wiping 80, 127, 176
printer hard disk
encryption 81, 128, 176
printer hard disk memory
erasing 80, 127, 176
printer information
where to find 8
printer IP address
finding 89, 137
printer is printing blank
pages 327
printer messages
Cartridge, imaging unit
mismatch [41.xy] 282
Change [paper source] to
[custom string] load
[orientation] 282
Change [paper source] to
[custom type name] load
[orientation] 282
Change [paper source] to
[paper size] load
[orientation] 282
Change [paper source] to
[paper type] [paper size] load
[orientation] 282
Check tray [x] connection 283
Close door or insert
cartridge 283
Close finisher rear door 283
Close rear door 283
Complex page, some data may
not have printed [39] 283
Configuration change, some
held jobs were not restored
[57] 284
Defective flash detected
[51] 284
Disk full [62] 284
Disk must be formatted for use
in this device 284
Disk near full. Securely clearing
disk space. 284
Empty the hole punch box 285
Error reading USB drive.
Remove USB. 285
Error reading USB hub. Remove
hub. 285
Imaging unit low [84.xy] 285
Imaging unit nearly low
[84.xy] 285
Imaging unit very low, [x]
estimated pages remain
[84.xy] 285
Incompatible output bin [x]
[59] 285
Incompatible tray [x] [59] 286
Incorrect paper size, open
[paper source] [34] 286
Insert hole punch box 286
Insert staple cartridge 286
Insert Tray [x] 286
Install bin [x] 287
Install Tray [x] 287
Insucient memory for Flash
Memory Defragment operation
[37] 287
Insucient memory to collate
job [37] 288
Insucient memory to support
Resource Save feature
[35] 288
Insucient memory, some Held
Jobs were deleted [37] 287
Insucient memory, some held
jobs will not be restored
[37] 288
Load [paper source] with
[custom string] [paper
orientation] 288
Load [paper source] with
[custom type name] [paper
orientation] 288
Load [paper source] with [paper
size] [paper orientation] 289
Load [paper source] with [paper
type] [paper size] [paper
orientation] 289
Load multipurpose feeder with
[custom type name]
[orientation] 289
Load multipurpose feeder with
[paper size] [orientation] 290
Load multipurpose feeder with
[paper type] [paper size]
[orientation] 290
Load multipurpose feeder with
custom string]
[orientation] 289
Load staples 290
Maintenance kit low
[80.xy] 290
Maintenance kit nearly low
[80.xy] 290
Maintenance kit very low
[80.xy] 291
Memory full [38] 291
Misfeed cleared, extra sheets in
output bin [24y.xx] 291
Network [x] software error
[54] 291
NonLexmark [supply type], see
User’s Guide [33.xy] 291
Not enough free space in flash
memory for resources
[52] 292
Paper changes needed 292
Parallel port [x] disabled
[56] 292
Printer had to restart. Last job
may be incomplete. 292
Reattach bin [x] 293
Reattach bins [x] – [y] 293
Reinstall missing or
unresponsive cartridge
[31.xy] 294
Index
358
background
Reinstall missing or
unresponsive imaging unit
[31.xy] 294
Remove defective disk [61] 294
Remove packaging material,
[area name] 294
Remove paper from [linked set
bin name] 295
Remove paper from all
bins 294
Remove paper from bin [x] 294
Remove paper from standard
output bin 295
Replace cartridge, printer region
mismatch [42.xy] 295
Replace defective imaging unit
[31.xy] 295
Replace imaging unit, 0
estimated pages remain
[84.xy] 296
Replace maintenance kit to
resume printing [80.xy] 296
Replace maintenance kit,
recommended life exceeded
[80.xyz] 296
Replace missing cartridge
[31.xy] 296
Replace missing fuser
[31.xyz] 296
Replace missing imaging unit
[31.xy] 296
Replace roller kit [81.xx] 296
Replace unsupported cartridge
[32.xy] 296
Replace unsupported imaging
unit [32.xy] 297
Replace wiper 297
Restore held jobs? 298
Serial port [x] disabled [56] 298
Some held jobs were not
restored 298
Standard network software
error [54] 298
Standard USB port disabled
[56] 298
Supply needed to complete
job 299
The device is operating in safe
mode. Some print options may
be disabled or provide
unexpected results. 299
Too many bins attached
[58] 299
Too many disks installed
[58] 299
Too many flash options installed
[58] 299
Too many trays attached
[58] 299
Tray [x] paper size
unsupported 300
Unformatted flash detected
[53] 300
Unsupported disk 300
Unsupported option in slot [x]
[55] 300
Unsupported USB hub, please
remove 285
USB port [x] disabled [56] 300
printer options troubleshooting
internal option is not
detected 313
internal print server 314
Internal Solutions Port 314
tray problems 315
USB/parallel interface card 316
printer options, troubleshooting
2100sheet tray problems 312
printer problems, solving
basic 301
printer security
information on 82, 129, 177
printer setup
verifying 40
printer software, installing 35
printing
canceling, from printer control
panel 119
canceling, from the printer
control panel 168
directory list 71, 119, 167
font sample list 71, 119, 167
from a computer 66, 113, 162
from a mobile
device 69, 117, 165, 166
from flash drive 67, 115, 163
menu settings
page 74, 122, 170
network setup
page 75, 122, 170
printing a directory list 119, 167
printing a font sample list 119, 167
printing a menu settings
page 122, 170
printing a network setup
page 75, 122, 170
printing forms 114, 162
printing from a computer 113
printing from a flash
drive 67, 115, 163
printing held jobs
from a Macintosh
computer 71, 118, 167
from Windows 71, 118, 167
printing slows down 310
publications
where to find 8
Push Button Configuration
method
using 38
Q
Quality menu 236
Quiet mode 76, 123
using 172
R
Reattach bin [x] 293
Reattach bin [x] – [y] 293
recycled paper
using 181, 247
recycling
Lexmark packaging 248
Lexmark products 248
toner cartridges 248
reducing noise 76, 123
reducing printer noise 172
Reinstall missing or unresponsive
cartridge [31.xy] 294
Reinstall missing or unresponsive
imaging unit [31.xy] 294
remote control panel
using Embedded Web
Server 72
Remote Operator Panel
setting up 92, 140
Remove defective disk [61] 294
Remove packaging material,
[area name] 294
Remove paper from [linked set
bin name] 295
Remove paper from all bins 294
Remove paper from bin [x] 294
Index 359
background
Remove paper from standard
output bin 295
removing printer hard disk 27
repeat print jobs 70, 118, 166
printing from a Macintosh
computer 167
printing from Windows 167
repeating defects appear on
prints 329
Replace cartridge, printer region
mismatch [42.xy] 295
Replace defective imaging unit
[31.xy] 295
Replace imaging unit, 0
estimated pages remain
[84.xy] 296
Replace maintenance kit to
resume printing [80.xy] 296
Replace maintenance kit,
recommended life exceeded
[80.xyz] 296
Replace missing cartridge
[31.xy] 296
Replace missing fuser
[31.xyz] 296
Replace missing imaging unit
[31.xy] 296
Replace roller kit [81.xx] 296
Replace unsupported cartridge
[32.xy] 296
Replace unsupported imaging
unit [32.xy] 297
Replace wiper 297
replacing a staple cartridge 259
replacing supplies
staple cartridge 259
replacing the toner
cartridge 254, 256
Reports menu 201
reserve print jobs 70, 166
printing from a Macintosh
computer 167
printing from
Windows 71, 118, 167
Restore held jobs? 298
restoring factory default
settings 124, 173
roller kit
ordering 252
S
safety information 5, 6, 7
security
modifying confidential print
settings 73, 121, 169
Security Audit Log menu 218
security lock 78, 125, 174
security settings
erasing 80
security settings information
erasing 127, 175
security Web page
where to find 82, 129, 177
selecting a location for the
printer 10, 11
selecting paper 181
Serial [x] menu 212
Serial port [x] disabled [56] 298
serial printing
setting up 40
Set Date and Time menu 218
setting
paper size 44, 93, 141
paper type 44, 93, 141
TCP/IP address 205
setting the Universal paper
size 93, 141
setting Universal paper size 44
setting up serial printing 40
Setup menu 231
shipping the printer 262
showing icons on the home
screen 90, 138
Sleep button
printer control panel 43, 85, 132
Sleep Mode
adjusting 124
Sleep mode
adjusting 77, 173
SMTP Setup menu 214
Some held jobs were not
restored 298
standard 250sheet tray
loading 45, 142
standard 550sheet tray
loading 45, 93, 142
Standard Network menu 202
Standard network software error
[54] 298
standard tray
loading 45, 93, 142
Standard USB menu 208
Standard USB port disabled
[56] 298
staple cartridge
replacing 259
staple cartridges
ordering 252
staple jam in the finisher 276
statement of
volatility 78, 125, 174
status of parts
checking 122, 171
status of parts and supplies
checking 75
status of supplies
checking 122, 171
Stop or Cancel button
printer control panel 43, 85, 132
storing
paper 182
supplies 253
storing print jobs 70, 118, 166
streaked horizontal lines appear
on prints 331
streaked vertical lines appear on
prints 332
streaks appear 336
Substitute Size menu 193
supplies
checking status 75, 122, 171
checking, from printer control
panel 122
checking, on the printer control
panel 171
checking, using the Embedded
Web Server 75, 122, 171
conserving 248
storing 253
using genuine Lexmark 250
using recycled paper 247
supplies, ordering
imaging unit 252
maintenance kit 252
roller kit 252
staple cartridges 252
toner cartridges 250
Supply needed to complete
job 299
supply notifications
configuring 72, 120, 168
supported flash
drives 68, 116, 164
supported paper sizes 183
supported paper types 183
supported paper weights 183
Index 360
background
T
TCP/IP menu 205
The device is operating in safe
mode. Some print options may
be disabled or provide
unexpected results. 299
tips
card stock 178
labels, paper 179
on using envelopes 178
transparencies 179
tips on using envelopes 178
toner cartridge
replacing 254, 256
toner cartridges
ordering 250
recycling 248
toner darkness
adjusting 66, 114, 163
Too many bins attached [58] 299
Too many disks installed
[58] 299
Too many flash options installed
[58] 299
Too many trays attached
[58] 299
touch screen
buttons, using 88, 134
transparencies
loading 59, 107, 156
tips 179
Tray [x] paper size
unsupported 300
trays
linking 64, 112, 113, 161, 162
unlinking 64, 112, 113, 161, 162
troubleshooting
an application error has
occurred 337
cannot open Embedded Web
Server 338
checking an unresponsive
printer 301
solving basic printer
problems 301
troubleshooting, display
printer display is blank 303
troubleshooting, paper feed
message remains after jam is
cleared 317
troubleshooting, print
confidential and other held
documents do not print 303
envelope seals when
printing 304
error reading flash drive 305
incorrect characters print 306
incorrect margins on prints 322
jammed pages are not
reprinted 316
job prints from wrong tray 306
job prints on wrong paper 306
jobs do not print 309
Large jobs do not collate 307
multiplelanguage PDF files do
not print 307
paper curl 323
paper frequently jams 317
print job takes longer than
expected 308
tray linking does not work 310
unexpected page breaks
occur 311
troubleshooting, print quality
blank pages 327
characters have jagged
edges 318
clipped pages or images 318
compressed images appear on
prints 319
gray background on prints 320
horizontal voids appear on
prints 321
print irregularities 323
print is too dark 325
print is too light 326
printer is printing solid black
pages 328
repeating defects appear on
prints 329
shadow images appear on
prints 330
skewed print 330
streaked horizontal lines appear
on prints 331
streaked vertical lines 332
toner fog or background
shading appears on prints 334
toner rubs o 334
toner specks appear on
prints 335
transparency print quality is
poor 335
uneven print density 335
white streaks on a page 336
troubleshooting, printer options
2100sheet tray problems 312
internal option is not
detected 313
internal print server 314
Internal Solutions Port 314
tray problems 315
USB/parallel interface card 316
troubleshooting, printing
printing slows down 310
U
understanding the home
screen 86, 133
uneven print density 335
Unformatted flash detected
[53] 300
Universal Paper Size
setting 93
Universal paper size
setting 44, 141
Universal Setup menu 199
unlinking
trays 64, 112, 113, 161, 162
Unsupported disk 300
Unsupported option in slot [x]
[55] 300
Unsupported USB hub, please
remove 285
USB port 33
printer control panel 43, 85, 132
USB port [x] disabled [56] 300
USB/parallel interface card
troubleshooting 316
User’s Guide
using 8
using Hibernate
mode 77, 124, 173
using Quiet mode 172
using recycled paper 247
using the printer control
panel 43, 85, 132
using the touchscreen
buttons 88, 134
Utilities menu 238
Index 361
background
V
verify print jobs 70, 118, 166
printing from a Macintosh
computer 167
printing from Windows 167
verifying printer setup 40
vertical voids appear 336
virtual display
checking, using Embedded Web
Server 120, 168
voids appear 336
volatile memory 78, 125, 174
erasing 79, 126, 175
volatility
statement of 78, 125, 174
W
wiping printer hard disk 80
wiping the printer hard
disk 127, 176
Wireless menu 206
wireless network
configuration information 36
wireless network setup
using the Embedded Web
Server 39
wireless setup wizard
using 37
X
XPS menu 238
Index 362

Specifications

Lexmark MS812DN Questions and Answers

See other models: C746N MS810DN MS810 MX711DE MS811DTN